*** empty log message ***
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
CommitLineData
c906108c 1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
b6ba6518 2@c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
1e698235 3@c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003
c906108c
SS
4@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5@c
5d161b24 6@c %**start of header
c906108c
SS
7@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9@setfilename gdb.info
10@c
11@include gdb-cfg.texi
12@c
c906108c 13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
14@setchapternewpage odd
15@c %**end of header
16
17@iftex
18@c @smallbook
19@c @cropmarks
20@end iftex
21
22@finalout
23@syncodeindex ky cp
24
41afff9a 25@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
48e934c6 26@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
c906108c 27@syncodeindex vr cp
41afff9a 28@syncodeindex fn cp
c906108c
SS
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
e9c75b65 31@set EDITION Ninth
c906108c
SS
32
33@c !!set GDB manual's revision date
87885426
FN
34@set DATE June 2002
35
36@c !!set GDB edit command default editor
37@set EDITOR /bin/ex
c906108c 38
6c0e9fb3 39@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
c906108c 40
c906108c 41@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
6d2ebf8b 42@c manuals to an info tree.
96a2c332
SS
43@dircategory Programming & development tools.
44@direntry
c906108c 45* Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
96a2c332
SS
46@end direntry
47
c906108c
SS
48@ifinfo
49This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
50
51
5d161b24 52This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
c906108c
SS
53of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
54for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
55
8a037dd7 56Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
1e698235 57 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 58
e9c75b65
EZ
59Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
60under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
61any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
959acfd1
EZ
62Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
63Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
64and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
c906108c 65
6826cf00
EZ
66(a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
67freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
68published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
69development.''
c906108c
SS
70@end ifinfo
71
72@titlepage
73@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
74@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
c906108c 75@sp 1
c906108c
SS
76@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
77@subtitle @value{DATE}
9e9c5ae7 78@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
c906108c 79@page
c906108c
SS
80@tex
81{\parskip=0pt
53a5351d 82\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
c906108c
SS
83\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
84\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
85}
86@end tex
53a5351d 87
c906108c 88@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
8a037dd7 89Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
1e698235 901996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 91@sp 2
c906108c
SS
92Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
9359 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
94Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
6d2ebf8b 95ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
e9c75b65
EZ
96
97Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
98under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
99any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
959acfd1
EZ
100Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
101Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
102and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
e9c75b65 103
6826cf00
EZ
104(a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
105freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
106published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
107development.''
c906108c
SS
108@end titlepage
109@page
110
6c0e9fb3 111@ifnottex
6d2ebf8b
SS
112@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
113
c906108c
SS
114@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
115
116This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
117
5d161b24 118This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
c906108c
SS
119@value{GDBVN}.
120
1e698235 121Copyright (C) 1988-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6d2ebf8b
SS
122
123@menu
124* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
125* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
126
127* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
128* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
129* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
130* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
131* Stack:: Examining the stack
132* Source:: Examining source files
133* Data:: Examining data
e2e0bcd1 134* Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
b37052ae 135* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
df0cd8c5 136* Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
6d2ebf8b
SS
137
138* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
139
140* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
141* Altering:: Altering execution
142* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
143* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
6b2f586d 144* Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
6d2ebf8b
SS
145* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
146* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
147* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
c4555f82 148* TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
6d2ebf8b
SS
149* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
150* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
7162c0ca 151* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
6d2ebf8b
SS
152
153* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
154* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
155
156* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
157* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
158* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
eb12ee30 159* Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
e0ce93ac 160* Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
aab4e0ec
AC
161* Copying:: GNU General Public License says
162 how you can copy and share GDB
6826cf00 163* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
6d2ebf8b
SS
164* Index:: Index
165@end menu
166
6c0e9fb3 167@end ifnottex
c906108c 168
449f3b6c 169@contents
449f3b6c 170
6d2ebf8b 171@node Summary
c906108c
SS
172@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
173
174The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
175going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
176program was doing at the moment it crashed.
177
178@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
179these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
180
181@itemize @bullet
182@item
183Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
184
185@item
186Make your program stop on specified conditions.
187
188@item
189Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
190
191@item
192Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
193effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
194@end itemize
195
cce74817 196You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
c906108c 197For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
c906108c
SS
198For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
199
cce74817 200@cindex Modula-2
e632838e
AC
201Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
202@ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
c906108c 203
cce74817
JM
204@cindex Pascal
205Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
206nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
207entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
208syntax.
c906108c 209
c906108c
SS
210@cindex Fortran
211@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
53a5351d 212it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
cce74817 213underscore.
c906108c 214
c906108c
SS
215@menu
216* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
217* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
218@end menu
219
6d2ebf8b 220@node Free Software
c906108c
SS
221@unnumberedsec Free software
222
5d161b24 223@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
c906108c
SS
224General Public License
225(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
226program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
227freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
228the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
229Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
230Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
231
232Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
233you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
234from anyone else.
235
2666264b 236@unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
959acfd1
EZ
237
238The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
239the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
240include with the free software. Many of our most important
241programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
242texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
243when an important free software package does not come with a free
244manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
245gaps today.
246
247Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
248normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
249authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
250copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
251them from the free software world.
252
253That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
254from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
255manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
256only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
257contract to make it non-free.
258
259Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
260price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
261charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
262Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
263problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
264are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
265modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
266
267The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
268free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
269commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
270accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
271
272Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
273When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
274are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
275provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
276manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
277a changed version of the program is not really available to our
278community.
279
280Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
281acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
282author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
283authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
284to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
285may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
286with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
287are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
288of the manual.
289
290However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
291content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
292media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
293obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
294manual to replace it.
295
296Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
297lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
298free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
299the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
300realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
301the free software community.
302
303If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
304the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
305license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
306don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
307will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
308option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
309what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
310try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
42584a72 311is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
959acfd1
EZ
312
313You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
314manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
315copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
316improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
317at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
318and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
72c9928d
EZ
319Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
320have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
959acfd1
EZ
321
322The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
323published by other publishers, at
324@url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
325
6d2ebf8b 326@node Contributors
96a2c332
SS
327@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
328
329Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
330other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
331development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
332of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
333to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
334file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
c906108c
SS
335blow-by-blow account.
336
337Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
338
339@quotation
340@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
341or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
342omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
343@end quotation
344
345So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
346particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
347releases:
299ffc64 348Andrew Cagney (releases 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
c906108c
SS
349Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
350Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
351Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
352Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
353Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
354John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
355Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
356and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
357
358Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
359Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
360
b37052ae
EZ
361Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
362in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
363Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
364demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
365much general update work leading to release 3.0).
c906108c 366
b37052ae 367@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
c906108c
SS
368object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
369Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
370
371David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
372the original support for encapsulated COFF.
373
96c405b3 374Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF2 support.
c906108c
SS
375
376Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
377Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
378support.
379Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
380Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
381Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
382David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
383Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
384Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
385Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
386Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
387Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
388Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
389Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
390Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
391Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
392Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
393Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
a37295f9 394Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
c906108c 395
1104b9e7 396Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
c906108c
SS
397
398Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
399libraries.
400
401Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
402about several machine instruction sets.
403
404Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
405remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
406contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
407and RDI targets, respectively.
408
409Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
410command-line editing and command history.
411
7a292a7a
SS
412Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
413Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
c906108c 414
5d161b24 415Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
b37052ae 416He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
c906108c 417symbols.
c906108c
SS
418
419Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
420Super-H processors.
421
422NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
423
424Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
425
426Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
427
428Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
429
96a2c332 430Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
c906108c
SS
431
432Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
433watchpoints.
434
435Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
436
437Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
438
439Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
96a2c332 440nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
441
442The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
443support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
b37052ae 444(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
c906108c
SS
445compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
446John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
447Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
448information in this manual.
449
b37052ae
EZ
450DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
451Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
452
96a2c332
SS
453Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
454development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
2df3850c
JM
455fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
456Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
457Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
458Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
459Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
460addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
461JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
462Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
463Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
464Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
465Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
466Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
467Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
c906108c 468
e2e0bcd1
JB
469Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
470Hat.
c906108c 471
6d2ebf8b 472@node Sample Session
c906108c
SS
473@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
474
475You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
476However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
477debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
478
479@iftex
480In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
481to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
482@end iftex
483
484@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
485@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
486
487One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
488processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
489quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
490definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
491session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
492then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
493same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
494@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
495procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
496
497@smallexample
498$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
499$ @b{./m4}
500@b{define(foo,0000)}
501
502@b{foo}
5030000
504@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
505
506@b{bar}
5070000
508@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
509
510@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
511@b{baz}
512@b{C-d}
513m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
514@end smallexample
515
516@noindent
517Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
518
c906108c
SS
519@smallexample
520$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
521@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
522@c FIXME... format to come out better.
523@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 524 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
c906108c 525 the conditions.
5d161b24 526There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
c906108c
SS
527 for details.
528
529@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
530(@value{GDBP})
531@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
532
533@noindent
534@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
535rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
536We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
537that examples fit in this manual.
538
539@smallexample
540(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
541@end smallexample
542
543@noindent
544We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
545Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
546@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
547@code{break} command.
548
549@smallexample
550(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
551Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
552@end smallexample
553
554@noindent
555Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
556control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
557subroutine, the program runs as usual:
558
559@smallexample
560(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
561Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
562@b{define(foo,0000)}
563
564@b{foo}
5650000
566@end smallexample
567
568@noindent
569To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
570suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
571context where it stops.
572
573@smallexample
574@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
575
5d161b24 576Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
577 at builtin.c:879
578879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
579@end smallexample
580
581@noindent
582Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
583the next line of the current function.
584
585@smallexample
586(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
587882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
588 : nil,
589@end smallexample
590
591@noindent
592@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
593by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
594@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
595subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
596
597@smallexample
598(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
599set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
600 at input.c:530
601530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
602@end smallexample
603
604@noindent
605The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
606suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
607shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
608command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
609in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
610stack frame for each active subroutine.
611
612@smallexample
613(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
614#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
615 at input.c:530
5d161b24 616#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
617 at builtin.c:882
618#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
619#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
620 at macro.c:71
621#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
622#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
623@end smallexample
624
625@noindent
626We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
627times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
628falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
629
630@smallexample
631(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6320x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
633(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6340x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
635def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
636(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
637536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
638 : xstrdup(rq);
639(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
640538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
641@end smallexample
642
643@noindent
644The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
645@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
646and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
647(@code{print}) to see their values.
648
649@smallexample
650(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
651$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
652(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
653$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
654@end smallexample
655
656@noindent
657@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
658To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
659surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
660
661@smallexample
662(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
663533 xfree(rquote);
664534
665535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
666 : xstrdup (lq);
667536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
668 : xstrdup (rq);
669537
670538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
671539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
672540 @}
673541
674542 void
675@end smallexample
676
677@noindent
678Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
679@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
680
681@smallexample
682(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
683539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
684(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
685540 @}
686(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
687$3 = 9
688(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
689$4 = 7
690@end smallexample
691
692@noindent
693That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
694@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
695@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
696the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
697any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
698assignments.
699
700@smallexample
701(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
702$5 = 7
703(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
704$6 = 9
705@end smallexample
706
707@noindent
708Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
709@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
710executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
711example that caused trouble initially:
712
713@smallexample
714(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
715Continuing.
716
717@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
718
719baz
7200000
721@end smallexample
722
723@noindent
724Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
725problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
726lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
727
728@smallexample
729@b{C-d}
730Program exited normally.
731@end smallexample
732
733@noindent
734The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
735indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
736session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
737
738@smallexample
739(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
740@end smallexample
c906108c 741
6d2ebf8b 742@node Invocation
c906108c
SS
743@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
744
745This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
5d161b24 746The essentials are:
c906108c 747@itemize @bullet
5d161b24 748@item
53a5351d 749type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
5d161b24 750@item
c906108c
SS
751type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
752@end itemize
753
754@menu
755* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
756* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
757* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
758@end menu
759
6d2ebf8b 760@node Invoking GDB
c906108c
SS
761@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
762
c906108c
SS
763Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
764@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
765
766You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
767to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
768
c906108c
SS
769The command-line options described here are designed
770to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
5d161b24 771options may effectively be unavailable.
c906108c
SS
772
773The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
774specifying an executable program:
775
474c8240 776@smallexample
c906108c 777@value{GDBP} @var{program}
474c8240 778@end smallexample
c906108c 779
c906108c
SS
780@noindent
781You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
782specified:
783
474c8240 784@smallexample
c906108c 785@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
474c8240 786@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
787
788You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
789to debug a running process:
790
474c8240 791@smallexample
c906108c 792@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
474c8240 793@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
794
795@noindent
796would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
797named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
798
c906108c 799Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
2df3850c
JM
800complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
801debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
802``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
803will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
c906108c 804
aa26fa3a
TT
805You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
806executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
807option processing.
474c8240 808@smallexample
aa26fa3a 809gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
474c8240 810@end smallexample
aa26fa3a
TT
811This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
812@code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
813
96a2c332 814You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
c906108c
SS
815@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
816
817@smallexample
818@value{GDBP} -silent
819@end smallexample
820
821@noindent
822You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
823options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
824
825@noindent
826Type
827
474c8240 828@smallexample
c906108c 829@value{GDBP} -help
474c8240 830@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
831
832@noindent
833to display all available options and briefly describe their use
834(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
835
836All options and command line arguments you give are processed
837in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
838@samp{-x} option is used.
839
840
841@menu
c906108c
SS
842* File Options:: Choosing files
843* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
844@end menu
845
6d2ebf8b 846@node File Options
c906108c
SS
847@subsection Choosing files
848
2df3850c 849When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
c906108c
SS
850specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
851the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
19837790
MS
852@samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
853first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
854equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
855second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
856equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
857If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
858first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
859to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
860a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
79f12247 861prefixing it with @file{./}, eg. @file{./12345}.
7a292a7a
SS
862
863If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
864such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
865argument and ignore it.
c906108c
SS
866
867Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
868following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
869them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
870(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
871than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
872
d700128c
EZ
873@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
874@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
875@c it.
876
c906108c
SS
877@table @code
878@item -symbols @var{file}
879@itemx -s @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
880@cindex @code{--symbols}
881@cindex @code{-s}
c906108c
SS
882Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
883
884@item -exec @var{file}
885@itemx -e @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
886@cindex @code{--exec}
887@cindex @code{-e}
7a292a7a
SS
888Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
889and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
c906108c
SS
890
891@item -se @var{file}
d700128c 892@cindex @code{--se}
c906108c
SS
893Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
894file.
895
c906108c
SS
896@item -core @var{file}
897@itemx -c @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
898@cindex @code{--core}
899@cindex @code{-c}
19837790 900Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
c906108c
SS
901
902@item -c @var{number}
19837790
MS
903@item -pid @var{number}
904@itemx -p @var{number}
905@cindex @code{--pid}
906@cindex @code{-p}
907Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
908If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
909file named @var{number}.
c906108c
SS
910
911@item -command @var{file}
912@itemx -x @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
913@cindex @code{--command}
914@cindex @code{-x}
c906108c
SS
915Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
916Files,, Command files}.
917
918@item -directory @var{directory}
919@itemx -d @var{directory}
d700128c
EZ
920@cindex @code{--directory}
921@cindex @code{-d}
c906108c
SS
922Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
923
c906108c
SS
924@item -m
925@itemx -mapped
d700128c
EZ
926@cindex @code{--mapped}
927@cindex @code{-m}
c906108c
SS
928@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
929supported on all systems.}@*
930If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
5d161b24 931system call, you can use this option
c906108c
SS
932to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
933program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
96a2c332 934called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
c906108c
SS
935Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
936and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
937the symbol table from the executable program.
938
939The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
940is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
941table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c 942
c906108c
SS
943@item -r
944@itemx -readnow
d700128c
EZ
945@cindex @code{--readnow}
946@cindex @code{-r}
c906108c
SS
947Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
948the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
949This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
53a5351d 950
c906108c
SS
951@end table
952
2df3850c 953You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
c906108c 954order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
2df3850c
JM
955information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
956on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
957but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
c906108c 958
474c8240 959@smallexample
2df3850c 960gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
474c8240 961@end smallexample
c906108c 962
6d2ebf8b 963@node Mode Options
c906108c
SS
964@subsection Choosing modes
965
966You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
967batch mode or quiet mode.
968
969@table @code
970@item -nx
971@itemx -n
d700128c
EZ
972@cindex @code{--nx}
973@cindex @code{-n}
96565e91 974Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
2df3850c
JM
975@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
976options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
977files}.
c906108c
SS
978
979@item -quiet
d700128c 980@itemx -silent
c906108c 981@itemx -q
d700128c
EZ
982@cindex @code{--quiet}
983@cindex @code{--silent}
984@cindex @code{-q}
c906108c
SS
985``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
986messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
987
988@item -batch
d700128c 989@cindex @code{--batch}
c906108c
SS
990Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
991command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
992initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
993nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
994in the command files.
995
2df3850c
JM
996Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
997example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
998make this more useful, the message
c906108c 999
474c8240 1000@smallexample
c906108c 1001Program exited normally.
474c8240 1002@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1003
1004@noindent
2df3850c
JM
1005(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1006@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1007mode.
1008
1009@item -nowindows
1010@itemx -nw
d700128c
EZ
1011@cindex @code{--nowindows}
1012@cindex @code{-nw}
2df3850c 1013``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
96a2c332 1014(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
2df3850c
JM
1015interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1016
1017@item -windows
1018@itemx -w
d700128c
EZ
1019@cindex @code{--windows}
1020@cindex @code{-w}
2df3850c
JM
1021If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1022used if possible.
c906108c
SS
1023
1024@item -cd @var{directory}
d700128c 1025@cindex @code{--cd}
c906108c
SS
1026Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1027instead of the current directory.
1028
c906108c
SS
1029@item -fullname
1030@itemx -f
d700128c
EZ
1031@cindex @code{--fullname}
1032@cindex @code{-f}
7a292a7a
SS
1033@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1034subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1035number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1036displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1037recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1038the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1039and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1040@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1041frame.
c906108c 1042
d700128c
EZ
1043@item -epoch
1044@cindex @code{--epoch}
1045The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1046@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1047routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1048separate window.
1049
1050@item -annotate @var{level}
1051@cindex @code{--annotate}
1052This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1053effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1054(@pxref{Annotations}).
1055Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
1056together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
1057types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
1058@value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
1059maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
1060
1061@item -async
1062@cindex @code{--async}
1063Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1064@value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
1065special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
1066commands in parallel with the debugged process being
1067run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
1068MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
1069suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
1070control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
b37052ae 1071(@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
d700128c
EZ
1072operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1073yet.)
1074@c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1075@c should be removed.
1076
1077When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1078uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1079@samp{-noasync} option.
1080
1081@item -noasync
1082@cindex @code{--noasync}
1083Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1084
aa26fa3a
TT
1085@item --args
1086@cindex @code{--args}
1087Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1088executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1089This option stops option processing.
1090
2df3850c
JM
1091@item -baud @var{bps}
1092@itemx -b @var{bps}
d700128c
EZ
1093@cindex @code{--baud}
1094@cindex @code{-b}
c906108c
SS
1095Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1096interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
c906108c
SS
1097
1098@item -tty @var{device}
d700128c
EZ
1099@itemx -t @var{device}
1100@cindex @code{--tty}
1101@cindex @code{-t}
c906108c
SS
1102Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1103@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
c906108c 1104
53a5351d 1105@c resolve the situation of these eventually
c4555f82
SC
1106@item -tui
1107@cindex @code{--tui}
1108Activate the Terminal User Interface when starting.
1109The Terminal User Interface manages several text windows on the terminal,
1110showing source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1111(@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}).
1112Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs
1113(@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
53a5351d
JM
1114
1115@c @item -xdb
d700128c 1116@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
53a5351d
JM
1117@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1118@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1119@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1120@c systems.
1121
d700128c
EZ
1122@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1123@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1124Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1125program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
94bbb2c0
AC
1126communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1127
da0f9dcd
AC
1128@samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1129@value{GDBN} to use the current @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface}
1130(@pxref{GDB/MI, , The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}). The previous @sc{gdb/mi}
1131interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3, can be selected with
1132@samp{--interpreter=mi1}. Earlier @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces
1133are not supported.
d700128c
EZ
1134
1135@item -write
1136@cindex @code{--write}
1137Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1138is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1139(@pxref{Patching}).
1140
1141@item -statistics
1142@cindex @code{--statistics}
1143This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1144memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1145
1146@item -version
1147@cindex @code{--version}
1148This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1149no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1150
c906108c
SS
1151@end table
1152
6d2ebf8b 1153@node Quitting GDB
c906108c
SS
1154@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1155@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1156@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1157
1158@table @code
1159@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
41afff9a 1160@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
96a2c332
SS
1161@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1162@itemx q
1163To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1164@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1165do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1166otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1167error code.
c906108c
SS
1168@end table
1169
1170@cindex interrupt
1171An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1172terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1173returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1174character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1175until a time when it is safe.
1176
c906108c
SS
1177If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1178device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1179(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
c906108c 1180
6d2ebf8b 1181@node Shell Commands
c906108c
SS
1182@section Shell commands
1183
1184If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1185debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1186just use the @code{shell} command.
1187
1188@table @code
1189@kindex shell
1190@cindex shell escape
1191@item shell @var{command string}
1192Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
c906108c 1193If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
d4f3574e
SS
1194shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1195(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
c906108c
SS
1196@end table
1197
1198The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1199You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1200@value{GDBN}:
1201
1202@table @code
1203@kindex make
1204@cindex calling make
1205@item make @var{make-args}
1206Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1207arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1208@end table
1209
6d2ebf8b 1210@node Commands
c906108c
SS
1211@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1212
1213You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1214name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1215@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1216key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1217show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1218
1219@menu
1220* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1221* Completion:: Command completion
1222* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1223@end menu
1224
6d2ebf8b 1225@node Command Syntax
c906108c
SS
1226@section Command syntax
1227
1228A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1229how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1230arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1231command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1232step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
96a2c332 1233with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
c906108c
SS
1234
1235@cindex abbreviation
1236@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1237unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1238documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1239abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1240equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1241names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1242arguments to the @code{help} command.
1243
1244@cindex repeating commands
41afff9a 1245@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
c906108c 1246A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
96a2c332 1247repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
c906108c
SS
1248will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1249repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1250repeat.
1251
1252The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1253@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1254exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1255
1256@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1257output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1258(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1259@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1260repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1261
41afff9a 1262@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
c906108c
SS
1263@cindex comment
1264Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1265nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1266Files,,Command files}).
1267
88118b3a
TT
1268@cindex repeating command sequences
1269@kindex C-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1270The @kbd{C-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1271commands. This command accepts the current line, like @kbd{RET}, and
1272then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1273for editing.
1274
6d2ebf8b 1275@node Completion
c906108c
SS
1276@section Command completion
1277
1278@cindex completion
1279@cindex word completion
1280@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1281only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1282are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1283commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1284
1285Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1286of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1287word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1288enter it). For example, if you type
1289
1290@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1291@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1292@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1293@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
474c8240 1294@smallexample
c906108c 1295(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
474c8240 1296@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1297
1298@noindent
1299@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1300the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1301
474c8240 1302@smallexample
c906108c 1303(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
474c8240 1304@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1305
1306@noindent
1307You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1308breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1309@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1310were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1311might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1312to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1313
1314If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1315@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1316characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1317@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1318example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1319begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1320just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1321function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1322example:
1323
474c8240 1324@smallexample
c906108c
SS
1325(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1326@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
5d161b24
DB
1327make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1328make_abs_section make_function_type
1329make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1330make_cleanup make_reference_type
c906108c
SS
1331make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1332(@value{GDBP}) b make_
474c8240 1333@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1334
1335@noindent
1336After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1337partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1338command.
1339
1340If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
b37052ae 1341can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
7a292a7a 1342means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
c906108c 1343key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
7a292a7a 1344one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
c906108c
SS
1345
1346@cindex quotes in commands
1347@cindex completion of quoted strings
1348Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
7a292a7a
SS
1349parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1350its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1351situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1352@value{GDBN} commands.
c906108c 1353
c906108c 1354The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
b37052ae
EZ
1355name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1356overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1357by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1358may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1359that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1360that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1361word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1362@code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1363@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1364when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
c906108c 1365
474c8240 1366@smallexample
96a2c332 1367(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
c906108c
SS
1368bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1369(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
474c8240 1370@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1371
1372In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1373quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1374completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1375place:
1376
474c8240 1377@smallexample
c906108c
SS
1378(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1379@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1380(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
474c8240 1381@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1382
1383@noindent
1384In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1385you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1386completion on an overloaded symbol.
1387
d4f3574e 1388For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
b37052ae 1389expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
c906108c 1390overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
b37052ae 1391see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c
SS
1392
1393
6d2ebf8b 1394@node Help
c906108c
SS
1395@section Getting help
1396@cindex online documentation
1397@kindex help
1398
5d161b24 1399You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
c906108c
SS
1400using the command @code{help}.
1401
1402@table @code
41afff9a 1403@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
c906108c
SS
1404@item help
1405@itemx h
1406You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1407display a short list of named classes of commands:
1408
1409@smallexample
1410(@value{GDBP}) help
1411List of classes of commands:
1412
2df3850c 1413aliases -- Aliases of other commands
c906108c 1414breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2df3850c 1415data -- Examining data
c906108c 1416files -- Specifying and examining files
2df3850c
JM
1417internals -- Maintenance commands
1418obscure -- Obscure features
1419running -- Running the program
1420stack -- Examining the stack
c906108c
SS
1421status -- Status inquiries
1422support -- Support facilities
96a2c332
SS
1423tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1424 stopping the program
c906108c 1425user-defined -- User-defined commands
c906108c 1426
5d161b24 1427Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
c906108c 1428commands in that class.
5d161b24 1429Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1430documentation.
1431Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1432(@value{GDBP})
1433@end smallexample
96a2c332 1434@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
c906108c
SS
1435
1436@item help @var{class}
1437Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1438list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1439help display for the class @code{status}:
1440
1441@smallexample
1442(@value{GDBP}) help status
1443Status inquiries.
1444
1445List of commands:
1446
1447@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1448@c to fit in smallbook page size.
2df3850c
JM
1449info -- Generic command for showing things
1450 about the program being debugged
1451show -- Generic command for showing things
1452 about the debugger
c906108c 1453
5d161b24 1454Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1455documentation.
1456Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1457(@value{GDBP})
1458@end smallexample
1459
1460@item help @var{command}
1461With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1462short paragraph on how to use that command.
1463
6837a0a2
DB
1464@kindex apropos
1465@item apropos @var{args}
1466The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1467commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1468@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1469
1470@smallexample
1471apropos reload
1472@end smallexample
1473
b37052ae
EZ
1474@noindent
1475results in:
6837a0a2
DB
1476
1477@smallexample
6d2ebf8b
SS
1478@c @group
1479set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1480 multiple times in one run
1481show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1482 multiple times in one run
1483@c @end group
6837a0a2
DB
1484@end smallexample
1485
c906108c
SS
1486@kindex complete
1487@item complete @var{args}
1488The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1489for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1490command you want completed. For example:
1491
1492@smallexample
1493complete i
1494@end smallexample
1495
1496@noindent results in:
1497
1498@smallexample
1499@group
2df3850c
JM
1500if
1501ignore
c906108c
SS
1502info
1503inspect
c906108c
SS
1504@end group
1505@end smallexample
1506
1507@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1508@end table
1509
1510In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1511and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1512of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1513manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1514under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1515all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1516
1517@c @group
1518@table @code
1519@kindex info
41afff9a 1520@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
c906108c
SS
1521@item info
1522This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1523program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1524with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1525registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1526You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1527@w{@code{help info}}.
1528
1529@kindex set
1530@item set
5d161b24 1531You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
c906108c
SS
1532@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1533@code{set prompt $}.
1534
1535@kindex show
1536@item show
5d161b24 1537In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
c906108c
SS
1538@value{GDBN} itself.
1539You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1540related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1541system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1542which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1543
1544@kindex info set
1545To display all the settable parameters and their current
1546values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1547@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1548@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1549@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1550@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1551@end table
1552@c @end group
1553
1554Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1555exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1556
1557@table @code
1558@kindex show version
1559@cindex version number
1560@item show version
1561Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2df3850c
JM
1562information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1563@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1564version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1565commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1566system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
96a2c332 1567variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2df3850c
JM
1568The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1569@value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
1570
1571@kindex show copying
1572@item show copying
1573Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1574
1575@kindex show warranty
1576@item show warranty
2df3850c 1577Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
96a2c332 1578if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2df3850c 1579
c906108c
SS
1580@end table
1581
6d2ebf8b 1582@node Running
c906108c
SS
1583@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1584
1585When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1586debugging information when you compile it.
7a292a7a
SS
1587
1588You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1589of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1590your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1591kill a child process.
c906108c
SS
1592
1593@menu
1594* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1595* Starting:: Starting your program
c906108c
SS
1596* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1597* Environment:: Your program's environment
c906108c
SS
1598
1599* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1600* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1601* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1602* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1603
1604* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1605* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1606@end menu
1607
6d2ebf8b 1608@node Compilation
c906108c
SS
1609@section Compiling for debugging
1610
1611In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1612debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1613is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1614variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1615and addresses in the executable code.
1616
1617To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1618the compiler.
1619
e2e0bcd1
JB
1620Most compilers do not include information about preprocessor macros in
1621the debugging information if you specify the @option{-g} flag alone,
1622because this information is rather large. Version 3.1 of @value{NGCC},
1623the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you specify the
1624options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1625debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1626``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact ways
1627to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1628@option{-g} alone.
1629
c906108c
SS
1630Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1631options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1632executables containing debugging information.
1633
53a5351d
JM
1634@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1635without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1636recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1637program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1638in pushing your luck.
c906108c
SS
1639
1640@cindex optimized code, debugging
1641@cindex debugging optimized code
1642When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1643optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1644really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1645exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1646variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1647variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1648
1649Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1650@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1651doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1652please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1653
1654Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1655@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1656format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1657
1658@need 2000
6d2ebf8b 1659@node Starting
c906108c
SS
1660@section Starting your program
1661@cindex starting
1662@cindex running
1663
1664@table @code
1665@kindex run
41afff9a 1666@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
c906108c
SS
1667@item run
1668@itemx r
7a292a7a
SS
1669Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1670You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1671argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1672@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1673(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
c906108c
SS
1674
1675@end table
1676
c906108c
SS
1677If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1678supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1679that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1680@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1681
1682The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1683receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1684information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1685can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1686your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1687divided into four categories:
1688
1689@table @asis
1690@item The @emph{arguments.}
1691Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1692@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1693is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1694(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1695the arguments.
1696In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1697@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1698@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1699
1700@item The @emph{environment.}
1701Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1702use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1703environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1704your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1705
1706@item The @emph{working directory.}
1707Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1708the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1709@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1710
1711@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1712Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1713standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1714in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1715set a different device for your program.
1716@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1717
1718@cindex pipes
1719@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1720pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1721program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1722wrong program.
1723@end table
c906108c
SS
1724
1725When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1726immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1727of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1728stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1729or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1730
1731If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1732time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1733table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1734your current breakpoints.
1735
6d2ebf8b 1736@node Arguments
c906108c
SS
1737@section Your program's arguments
1738
1739@cindex arguments (to your program)
1740The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
5d161b24 1741@code{run} command.
c906108c
SS
1742They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1743performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1744@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1745@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
d4f3574e
SS
1746the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1747
1748On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1749@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1750calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1751the program, not by the shell.
c906108c
SS
1752
1753@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1754@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1755
c906108c 1756@table @code
41afff9a 1757@kindex set args
c906108c
SS
1758@item set args
1759Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1760@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1761with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1762using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1763it again without arguments.
1764
1765@kindex show args
1766@item show args
1767Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1768@end table
1769
6d2ebf8b 1770@node Environment
c906108c
SS
1771@section Your program's environment
1772
1773@cindex environment (of your program)
1774The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1775their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1776your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1777path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1778the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1779debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1780environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1781
1782@table @code
1783@kindex path
1784@item path @var{directory}
1785Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
17cc6a06
EZ
1786(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1787The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
d4f3574e
SS
1788You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1789system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1790MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1791is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
c906108c
SS
1792
1793You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1794working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1795use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1796@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1797@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1798@var{directory} to the search path.
1799@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1800@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1801
1802@kindex show paths
1803@item show paths
1804Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1805environment variable).
1806
1807@kindex show environment
1808@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1809Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1810your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1811print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1812your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1813
1814@kindex set environment
53a5351d 1815@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
1816Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1817changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1818be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1819any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1820parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1821null value.
1822@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1823@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1824
1825For example, this command:
1826
474c8240 1827@smallexample
c906108c 1828set env USER = foo
474c8240 1829@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1830
1831@noindent
d4f3574e 1832tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
c906108c
SS
1833@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1834are not actually required.)
1835
1836@kindex unset environment
1837@item unset environment @var{varname}
1838Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1839program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1840@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1841rather than assigning it an empty value.
1842@end table
1843
d4f3574e
SS
1844@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1845the shell indicated
c906108c
SS
1846by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1847@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1848that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1849@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1850your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1851files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1852@file{.profile}.
1853
6d2ebf8b 1854@node Working Directory
c906108c
SS
1855@section Your program's working directory
1856
1857@cindex working directory (of your program)
1858Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1859working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1860The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1861from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1862working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1863
1864The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1865that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1866specify files}.
1867
1868@table @code
1869@kindex cd
1870@item cd @var{directory}
1871Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1872
1873@kindex pwd
1874@item pwd
1875Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1876@end table
1877
6d2ebf8b 1878@node Input/Output
c906108c
SS
1879@section Your program's input and output
1880
1881@cindex redirection
1882@cindex i/o
1883@cindex terminal
1884By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
5d161b24 1885the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
c906108c
SS
1886to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1887modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1888running your program.
1889
1890@table @code
1891@kindex info terminal
1892@item info terminal
1893Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1894program is using.
1895@end table
1896
1897You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1898redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1899
474c8240 1900@smallexample
c906108c 1901run > outfile
474c8240 1902@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1903
1904@noindent
1905starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1906
1907@kindex tty
1908@cindex controlling terminal
1909Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1910with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1911argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1912commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1913process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1914
474c8240 1915@smallexample
c906108c 1916tty /dev/ttyb
474c8240 1917@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1918
1919@noindent
1920directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1921default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1922that as their controlling terminal.
1923
1924An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1925effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1926terminal.
1927
1928When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1929command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1930for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1931
6d2ebf8b 1932@node Attach
c906108c
SS
1933@section Debugging an already-running process
1934@kindex attach
1935@cindex attach
1936
1937@table @code
1938@item attach @var{process-id}
1939This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1940outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1941targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1942find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1943or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1944
1945@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1946executing the command.
1947@end table
1948
1949To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1950which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1951programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1952also have permission to send the process a signal.
1953
1954When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1955the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1956the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1957(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1958the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1959Specify Files}.
1960
1961The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1962process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
53a5351d
JM
1963with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1964you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1965can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1966process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
c906108c
SS
1967attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1968
1969@table @code
1970@kindex detach
1971@item detach
1972When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1973@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1974the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1975that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1976are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1977@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1978executing the command.
1979@end table
1980
1981If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1982attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1983for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1984control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1985confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1986messages}).
1987
6d2ebf8b 1988@node Kill Process
c906108c 1989@section Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1990
1991@table @code
1992@kindex kill
1993@item kill
1994Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1995@end table
1996
1997This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1998running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1999is running.
2000
2001On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2002while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2003@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2004outside the debugger.
2005
2006The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2007relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2008executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2009next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2010reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2011breakpoint settings).
2012
6d2ebf8b 2013@node Threads
c906108c 2014@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
c906108c
SS
2015
2016@cindex threads of execution
2017@cindex multiple threads
2018@cindex switching threads
2019In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2020may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2021of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2022the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2023that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2024modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2025registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2026
2027@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2028programs:
2029
2030@itemize @bullet
2031@item automatic notification of new threads
2032@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2033@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
5d161b24 2034@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
c906108c
SS
2035a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2036@item thread-specific breakpoints
2037@end itemize
2038
c906108c
SS
2039@quotation
2040@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2041@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2042If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2043effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2044from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2045like this:
2046
2047@smallexample
2048(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2049(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2050Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2051see the IDs of currently known threads.
2052@end smallexample
2053@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2054@c doesn't support threads"?
2055@end quotation
c906108c
SS
2056
2057@cindex focus of debugging
2058@cindex current thread
2059The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2060threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2061control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2062This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2063program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2064
41afff9a 2065@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
c906108c
SS
2066@cindex thread identifier (system)
2067@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2068@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2069@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2070Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2071the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2072form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2073whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2074LynxOS, you might see
2075
474c8240 2076@smallexample
c906108c 2077[New process 35 thread 27]
474c8240 2078@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2079
2080@noindent
2081when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2082the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2083further qualifier.
2084
2085@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2086@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
6ca652b0 2087@c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
c906108c
SS
2088@c program?
2089@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2090@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
5d161b24 2091@c threads ab initio?
c906108c
SS
2092
2093@cindex thread number
2094@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2095For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2096number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2097
2098@table @code
2099@kindex info threads
2100@item info threads
2101Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2102program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2103
2104@enumerate
2105@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2106
2107@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2108
2109@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2110@end enumerate
2111
2112@noindent
2113An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2114indicates the current thread.
2115
5d161b24 2116For example,
c906108c
SS
2117@end table
2118@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2119
2120@smallexample
2121(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2122 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2123 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2124* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2125 at threadtest.c:68
2126@end smallexample
53a5351d
JM
2127
2128On HP-UX systems:
c906108c
SS
2129
2130@cindex thread number
2131@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2132For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2133number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2134thread in your program.
2135
41afff9a
EZ
2136@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2137@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
c906108c
SS
2138@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2139@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2140@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2141Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2142both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2143form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2144whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2145HP-UX, you see
2146
474c8240 2147@smallexample
c906108c 2148[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
474c8240 2149@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2150
2151@noindent
5d161b24 2152when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
c906108c
SS
2153
2154@table @code
2155@kindex info threads
2156@item info threads
2157Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2158program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2159
2160@enumerate
2161@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2162
2163@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2164
2165@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2166@end enumerate
2167
2168@noindent
2169An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2170indicates the current thread.
2171
5d161b24 2172For example,
c906108c
SS
2173@end table
2174@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2175
474c8240 2176@smallexample
c906108c 2177(@value{GDBP}) info threads
6d2ebf8b
SS
2178 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2179 at quicksort.c:137
2180 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2181 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2182 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2183 from /usr/lib/libc.2
474c8240 2184@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2185
2186@table @code
2187@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2188@item thread @var{threadno}
2189Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2190argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2191shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2192@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2193you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2194
2195@smallexample
2196@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2197(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
c906108c 2198[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
c906108c
SS
21990x34e5 in sigpause ()
2200@end smallexample
2201
2202@noindent
2203As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2204@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
5d161b24 2205threads.
c906108c
SS
2206
2207@kindex thread apply
2208@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2209The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2210more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2211with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2212@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
5d161b24
DB
2213threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2214@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
c906108c
SS
2215@end table
2216
2217@cindex automatic thread selection
2218@cindex switching threads automatically
2219@cindex threads, automatic switching
2220Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2221signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2222signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2223message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2224thread.
2225
2226@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2227more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2228programs with multiple threads.
2229
2230@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2231watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
c906108c 2232
6d2ebf8b 2233@node Processes
c906108c
SS
2234@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2235
2236@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2237@cindex multiple processes
2238@cindex processes, multiple
53a5351d
JM
2239On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2240programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2241function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2242parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2243set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2244will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2245will cause it to terminate.
c906108c
SS
2246
2247However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2248which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2249the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2250only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2251so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2252on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2253get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2254@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
d4f3574e 2255the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
c906108c 2256the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
c906108c 2257
53a5351d
JM
2258On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2259debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2260@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
c906108c
SS
2261
2262By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2263the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2264
2265If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2266use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2267
2268@table @code
2269@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2270@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2271Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2272@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2273process. The @var{mode} can be:
2274
2275@table @code
2276@item parent
2277The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2df3850c 2278unimpeded. This is the default.
c906108c
SS
2279
2280@item child
2281The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2282unimpeded.
2283
2284@item ask
2285The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2286@end table
2287
2288@item show follow-fork-mode
2df3850c 2289Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
c906108c
SS
2290@end table
2291
2292If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2293@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2294breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2295@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2296the child process's @code{main}.
2297
2298When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2299child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2300
2301If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2302call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2303use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2304argument.
2305
2306You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2307a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2308Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
c906108c 2309
6d2ebf8b 2310@node Stopping
c906108c
SS
2311@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2312
2313The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2314program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2315trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2316
7a292a7a
SS
2317Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2318such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2319@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2320change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2321continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2322ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2323explicitly request this information at any time.
c906108c
SS
2324
2325@table @code
2326@kindex info program
2327@item info program
2328Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
7a292a7a 2329running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
c906108c
SS
2330@end table
2331
2332@menu
2333* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2334* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
c906108c 2335* Signals:: Signals
c906108c 2336* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
c906108c
SS
2337@end menu
2338
6d2ebf8b 2339@node Breakpoints
c906108c
SS
2340@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2341
2342@cindex breakpoints
2343A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2344the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2345control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2346breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2347Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2348should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2349program.
2350
2351In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2352breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2353a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2354is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2355not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2356arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2357
2358@cindex watchpoints
2359@cindex memory tracing
2360@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2361@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2362A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2363when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2364command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2365watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2366any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2367and watchpoints using the same commands.
2368
2369You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2370whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2371Automatic display}.
2372
2373@cindex catchpoints
2374@cindex breakpoint on events
2375A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
b37052ae 2376when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
2377exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2378different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2379catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2380other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
d4f3574e 2381@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2382
2383@cindex breakpoint numbers
2384@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2385@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2386catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2387starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2388features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2389breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2390@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2391enable it again.
2392
c5394b80
JM
2393@cindex breakpoint ranges
2394@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2395Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2396operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2397@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2398hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2399all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2400
c906108c
SS
2401@menu
2402* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2403* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2404* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2405* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2406* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2407* Conditions:: Break conditions
2408* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
c906108c 2409* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
d4f3574e 2410* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2411@end menu
2412
6d2ebf8b 2413@node Set Breaks
c906108c
SS
2414@subsection Setting breakpoints
2415
5d161b24 2416@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
c906108c
SS
2417@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2418@c
2419@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2420
2421@kindex break
41afff9a
EZ
2422@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2423@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
2424@cindex latest breakpoint
2425Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
5d161b24 2426@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
f3b28801 2427number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
c906108c
SS
2428Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2429convenience variables.
2430
2431You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2432
2433@table @code
2434@item break @var{function}
5d161b24 2435Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
c906108c 2436When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
b37052ae 2437C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
c906108c 2438@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
c906108c
SS
2439
2440@item break +@var{offset}
2441@itemx break -@var{offset}
2442Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
d4f3574e 2443at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2df3850c 2444(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
c906108c
SS
2445
2446@item break @var{linenum}
2447Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
d4f3574e
SS
2448The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2449The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
c906108c
SS
2450code on that line.
2451
2452@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2453Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2454
2455@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2456Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2457@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2458superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2459functions.
2460
2461@item break *@var{address}
2462Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2463breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2464information or source files.
2465
2466@item break
2467When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2468the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2469(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2470innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2471returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2472@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2473that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2474@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2475the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2476inside loops.
2477
2478@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2479least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2480would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2481breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2482existed when your program stopped.
2483
2484@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2485Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2486@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2487value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2488@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2489above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2490,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2491
2492@kindex tbreak
2493@item tbreak @var{args}
2494Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2495same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2496way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2497program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2498
c906108c
SS
2499@kindex hbreak
2500@item hbreak @var{args}
d4f3574e
SS
2501Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2502@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
c906108c
SS
2503breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2504have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
d4f3574e
SS
2505debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2506changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2507provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2508will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2509address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2510breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2511example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2512@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2513or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2514(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2515
2516@kindex thbreak
2517@item thbreak @var{args}
2518Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2519are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
5d161b24 2520the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
c906108c
SS
2521the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2522first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
5d161b24
DB
2523command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2524may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
d4f3574e 2525See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2526
2527@kindex rbreak
2528@cindex regular expression
2529@item rbreak @var{regex}
c906108c 2530Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
11cf8741
JM
2531@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2532matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2533breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2534the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2535them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2536
2537The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2538like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2539shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2540an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2541@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2542match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
c906108c 2543
b37052ae 2544When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
c906108c
SS
2545breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2546classes.
c906108c
SS
2547
2548@kindex info breakpoints
2549@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2550@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2551@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2552@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2553Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2554not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2555
2556@table @emph
2557@item Breakpoint Numbers
2558@item Type
2559Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2560@item Disposition
2561Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2562@item Enabled or Disabled
2563Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2564that are not enabled.
2565@item Address
2df3850c 2566Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
c906108c
SS
2567@item What
2568Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2569line number.
2570@end table
2571
2572@noindent
2573If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2574the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2575are listed after that.
2576
2577@noindent
2578@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2579number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2580convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2581the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
5d161b24 2582listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
c906108c
SS
2583
2584@noindent
2585@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2586has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2587@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2588hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2589was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2590will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2591@end table
2592
2593@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2594your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2595the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2596(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2597
2598@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2599@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
eb12ee30
AC
2600@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
2601special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
2602programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
2603starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
c906108c 2604You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
eb12ee30 2605@samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
c906108c
SS
2606
2607
6d2ebf8b 2608@node Set Watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2609@subsection Setting watchpoints
2610
2611@cindex setting watchpoints
2612@cindex software watchpoints
2613@cindex hardware watchpoints
2614You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2615expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2616this may happen.
2617
2618Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2df3850c 2619hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
c906108c
SS
2620program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2621times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2622catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2623culprit.)
2624
1104b9e7 2625On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2df3850c 2626@value{GDBN} includes support for
c906108c
SS
2627hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2628program.
2629
2630@table @code
2631@kindex watch
2632@item watch @var{expr}
2633Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2634is written into by the program and its value changes.
2635
2636@kindex rwatch
2637@item rwatch @var{expr}
2638Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
c906108c
SS
2639
2640@kindex awatch
2641@item awatch @var{expr}
2df3850c 2642Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
7be570e7 2643by the program.
c906108c
SS
2644
2645@kindex info watchpoints
2646@item info watchpoints
2647This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2648it is the same as @code{info break}.
2649@end table
2650
2651@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2652watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2653value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2654cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2655executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2656statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2657
2658When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2659
474c8240 2660@smallexample
c906108c 2661Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
474c8240 2662@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2663
2664@noindent
2665if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2666
7be570e7
JM
2667Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2668hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2669value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2670every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2671that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2672hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2673will print a message like this:
2674
2675@smallexample
2676Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2677@end smallexample
2678
2679Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2680data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2681watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2682can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2683cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2684double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2685wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2686into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2687
2688If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2689to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2690Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2691time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2692able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2693warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2694
2695@smallexample
2696Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2697@end smallexample
2698
2699@noindent
2700If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2701
2702The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2703or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2704data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2705hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2706both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2707watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2708@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2709watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
c906108c
SS
2710@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2711Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2712
2713If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2df3850c 2714any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
c906108c
SS
2715kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2716
7be570e7
JM
2717@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2718(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2719they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2720which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2721being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2722and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2723rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2724way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2725@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2726
c906108c
SS
2727@quotation
2728@cindex watchpoints and threads
2729@cindex threads and watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2730@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2731usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2732can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2733you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2734thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2735can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2736@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2737the expression.
53a5351d 2738
d4f3574e 2739@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
53a5351d
JM
2740@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2741have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2742watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2743single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2744change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2745confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2746software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2747when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2748watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
c906108c 2749@end quotation
c906108c 2750
6d2ebf8b 2751@node Set Catchpoints
c906108c 2752@subsection Setting catchpoints
d4f3574e 2753@cindex catchpoints, setting
c906108c
SS
2754@cindex exception handlers
2755@cindex event handling
2756
2757You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
b37052ae 2758kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
c906108c
SS
2759shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2760
2761@table @code
2762@kindex catch
2763@item catch @var{event}
2764Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2765@table @code
2766@item throw
2767@kindex catch throw
b37052ae 2768The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2769
2770@item catch
2771@kindex catch catch
b37052ae 2772The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2773
2774@item exec
2775@kindex catch exec
2776A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2777
2778@item fork
2779@kindex catch fork
2780A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2781
2782@item vfork
2783@kindex catch vfork
2784A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2785
2786@item load
2787@itemx load @var{libname}
2788@kindex catch load
2789The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2790@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2791
2792@item unload
2793@itemx unload @var{libname}
2794@kindex catch unload
2795The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2796of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2797@end table
2798
2799@item tcatch @var{event}
2800Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2801automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2802
2803@end table
2804
2805Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2806
b37052ae 2807There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
2808(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2809
2810@itemize @bullet
2811@item
2812If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2813control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2814raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2815returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2816simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2817that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2818you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2819disabled within interactive calls.
2820
2821@item
2822You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2823
2824@item
2825You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2826@end itemize
2827
2828@cindex raise exceptions
2829Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2830if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2831stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2832can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2833breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2834out where the exception was raised.
2835
2836To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
b37052ae 2837knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
c906108c
SS
2838raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2839which has the following ANSI C interface:
2840
474c8240 2841@smallexample
c906108c 2842 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
d4f3574e
SS
2843 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2844 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
474c8240 2845@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2846
2847@noindent
2848To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2849unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2850(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2851
2852With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2853that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2854a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2855breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2856raised.
2857
2858
6d2ebf8b 2859@node Delete Breaks
c906108c
SS
2860@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2861
2862@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2863@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2864It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2865catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2866to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2867breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2868
2869With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2870where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2871delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2872their breakpoint numbers.
2873
2874It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2875automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2876when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2877
2878@table @code
2879@kindex clear
2880@item clear
2881Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2882selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2883the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2884breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2885
2886@item clear @var{function}
2887@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2888Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2889
2890@item clear @var{linenum}
2891@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2892Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2893
2894@cindex delete breakpoints
2895@kindex delete
41afff9a 2896@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
c5394b80
JM
2897@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2898Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2899ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
c906108c
SS
2900breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2901confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2902@end table
2903
6d2ebf8b 2904@node Disabling
c906108c
SS
2905@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2906
2907@kindex disable breakpoints
2908@kindex enable breakpoints
2909Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2910prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2911it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2912that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2913
2914You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2915the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2916or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2917@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2918catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2919
2920A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2921states of enablement:
2922
2923@itemize @bullet
2924@item
2925Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2926with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2927@item
2928Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2929@item
2930Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
d4f3574e 2931disabled.
c906108c
SS
2932@item
2933Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
d4f3574e
SS
2934immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2935set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
c906108c
SS
2936@end itemize
2937
2938You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2939watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2940
2941@table @code
2942@kindex disable breakpoints
2943@kindex disable
41afff9a 2944@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
c5394b80 2945@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2946Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2947listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2948options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2949case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2950@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2951
2952@kindex enable breakpoints
2953@kindex enable
c5394b80 2954@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2955Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2956become effective once again in stopping your program.
2957
c5394b80 2958@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2959Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2960of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2961
c5394b80 2962@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2963Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2964deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2965@end table
2966
d4f3574e
SS
2967@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2968@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
c906108c
SS
2969Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2970,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2971subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2972the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2973breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2974breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2975stepping}.)
2976
6d2ebf8b 2977@node Conditions
c906108c
SS
2978@subsection Break conditions
2979@cindex conditional breakpoints
2980@cindex breakpoint conditions
2981
2982@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
5d161b24 2983@c in particular for a watchpoint?
c906108c
SS
2984The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2985specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2986breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2987programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2988a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2989and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2990
2991This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2992situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2993when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2994by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2995@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2996
2997Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2998since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2999it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3000and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3001one.
3002
3003Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3004your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3005that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3006format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3007unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3008that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3009program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
d4f3574e
SS
3010breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3011conditions for the
c906108c
SS
3012purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3013(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
3014
3015Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3016@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3017Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3018with the @code{condition} command.
53a5351d 3019
c906108c
SS
3020You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3021The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3022@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3023catchpoint.
c906108c
SS
3024
3025@table @code
3026@kindex condition
3027@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3028Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3029watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3030breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3031@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3032@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3033syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
d4f3574e
SS
3034referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3035symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3036prints an error message:
3037
474c8240 3038@smallexample
d4f3574e 3039No symbol "foo" in current context.
474c8240 3040@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3041
3042@noindent
c906108c
SS
3043@value{GDBN} does
3044not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
d4f3574e
SS
3045command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3046@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
c906108c
SS
3047
3048@item condition @var{bnum}
3049Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3050an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3051@end table
3052
3053@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3054A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3055breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3056useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3057count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3058is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3059therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3060ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3061the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3062value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3063your program reaches it.
3064
3065@table @code
3066@kindex ignore
3067@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3068Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3069The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3070execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3071takes no action.
3072
3073To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3074a count of zero.
3075
3076When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3077breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3078@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3079Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3080
3081If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3082condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3083@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3084
3085You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3086as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3087is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3088variables}.
3089@end table
3090
3091Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3092
3093
6d2ebf8b 3094@node Break Commands
c906108c
SS
3095@subsection Breakpoint command lists
3096
3097@cindex breakpoint commands
3098You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3099commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3100example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3101enable other breakpoints.
3102
3103@table @code
3104@kindex commands
3105@kindex end
3106@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3107@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3108@itemx end
3109Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3110themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3111@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3112
3113To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3114follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3115
3116With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3117breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3118recently encountered).
3119@end table
3120
3121Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3122disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3123
3124You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3125use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3126that resumes execution.
3127
3128Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3129execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3130(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3131another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3132ambiguities about which list to execute.
3133
3134@kindex silent
3135If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3136usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3137be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3138then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3139see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3140meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3141
3142The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3143print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3144breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3145
3146For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3147value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3148
474c8240 3149@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3150break foo if x>0
3151commands
3152silent
3153printf "x is %d\n",x
3154cont
3155end
474c8240 3156@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3157
3158One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3159you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3160of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3161erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3162to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3163so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3164command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3165
474c8240 3166@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3167break 403
3168commands
3169silent
3170set x = y + 4
3171cont
3172end
474c8240 3173@end smallexample
c906108c 3174
6d2ebf8b 3175@node Breakpoint Menus
c906108c
SS
3176@subsection Breakpoint menus
3177@cindex overloading
3178@cindex symbol overloading
3179
b37052ae 3180Some programming languages (notably C@t{++}) permit a single function name
c906108c
SS
3181to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3182This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3183@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3184a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3185something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3186particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3187you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3188waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3189options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3190sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3191@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3192breakpoints.
3193
3194For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3195breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3196We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3197
3198@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3199@smallexample
3200@group
3201(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3202[0] cancel
3203[1] all
3204[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3205[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3206[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3207[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3208[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3209[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3210> 2 4 6
3211Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3212Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3213Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3214Multiple breakpoints were set.
3215Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3216 breakpoints.
3217(@value{GDBP})
3218@end group
3219@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3220
3221@c @ifclear BARETARGET
6d2ebf8b 3222@node Error in Breakpoints
d4f3574e 3223@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
3224@c
3225@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3226@c
d4f3574e
SS
3227Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3228any other process is running that program. In this situation,
5d161b24 3229attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
d4f3574e
SS
3230@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3231
474c8240 3232@smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3233Cannot insert breakpoints.
3234The same program may be running in another process.
474c8240 3235@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3236
3237When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3238
3239@enumerate
3240@item
3241Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3242
3243@item
5d161b24 3244Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
d4f3574e 3245name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
5d161b24 3246that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
d4f3574e
SS
3247Then start your program again.
3248
3249@item
3250Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3251linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3252to nonsharable executables.
3253@end enumerate
c906108c
SS
3254@c @end ifclear
3255
d4f3574e
SS
3256A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3257hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3258
3259@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3260@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3261@smallexample
3262Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3263You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3264@end smallexample
3265
3266@noindent
3267This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3268only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3269watchpoints it needs to insert.
3270
3271When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3272hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3273
3274
6d2ebf8b 3275@node Continuing and Stepping
c906108c
SS
3276@section Continuing and stepping
3277
3278@cindex stepping
3279@cindex continuing
3280@cindex resuming execution
3281@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3282completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3283one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3284line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
7a292a7a
SS
3285particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3286your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
d4f3574e
SS
3287it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3288@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
3289
3290@table @code
3291@kindex continue
41afff9a
EZ
3292@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3293@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
c906108c
SS
3294@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3295@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3296@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3297Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3298any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3299@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3300ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3301@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3302
3303The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3304stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3305@code{continue} is ignored.
3306
d4f3574e
SS
3307The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3308debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3309purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3310@code{continue}.
c906108c
SS
3311@end table
3312
3313To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3314(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3315calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3316different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3317
3318A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3319(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3320beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3321is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3322and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3323interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3324
3325@table @code
3326@kindex step
41afff9a 3327@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
c906108c
SS
3328@item step
3329Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3330line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3331abbreviated @code{s}.
3332
3333@quotation
3334@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3335@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3336@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3337@c distinction here.
3338@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3339within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3340execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3341debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3342is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3343without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3344below.
3345@end quotation
3346
4a92d011
EZ
3347The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3348line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3349@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3350to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3351the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3352called within the line.
c906108c 3353
d4f3574e
SS
3354Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3355number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5d161b24 3356@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
c906108c 3357on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5d161b24 3358was any debugging information about the routine.
c906108c
SS
3359
3360@item step @var{count}
3361Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
7a292a7a
SS
3362breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3363@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
c906108c
SS
3364
3365@kindex next
41afff9a 3366@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
c906108c
SS
3367@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3368Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
7a292a7a
SS
3369This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3370the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3371control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3372that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3373is abbreviated @code{n}.
c906108c
SS
3374
3375An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3376
3377
3378@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3379@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3380@c
3381@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3382@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3383@c function are executed without stopping.
3384
d4f3574e
SS
3385The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3386source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4a92d011 3387@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
c906108c 3388
b90a5f51
CF
3389@kindex set step-mode
3390@item set step-mode
3391@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3392@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3393@itemx set step-mode on
4a92d011 3394The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
b90a5f51
CF
3395stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3396information rather than stepping over it.
3397
4a92d011
EZ
3398This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3399machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3400want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
b90a5f51
CF
3401
3402@item set step-mode off
4a92d011 3403Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
b90a5f51
CF
3404debug information. This is the default.
3405
c906108c
SS
3406@kindex finish
3407@item finish
3408Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3409returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3410
3411Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3412,Returning from a function}).
3413
3414@kindex until
41afff9a 3415@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
c906108c
SS
3416@item until
3417@itemx u
3418Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3419current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3420stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3421command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3422automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3423than the address of the jump.
3424
3425This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3426though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3427exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3428simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3429through the next iteration.
3430
3431@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3432stack frame.
3433
3434@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3435of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3436example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3437(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3438@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3439
474c8240 3440@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3441(@value{GDBP}) f
3442#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3443206 expand_input();
3444(@value{GDBP}) until
3445195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
474c8240 3446@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3447
3448This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3449generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3450start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3451written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3452to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3453expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3454statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3455
3456@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3457instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3458argument.
3459
3460@item until @var{location}
3461@itemx u @var{location}
3462Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3463reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3464the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3465,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3466and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3467
3468@kindex stepi
41afff9a 3469@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
c906108c 3470@item stepi
96a2c332 3471@itemx stepi @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3472@itemx si
3473Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3474
3475It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3476instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3477instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3478Display,, Automatic display}.
3479
3480An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3481
3482@need 750
3483@kindex nexti
41afff9a 3484@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
c906108c 3485@item nexti
96a2c332 3486@itemx nexti @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3487@itemx ni
3488Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3489proceed until the function returns.
3490
3491An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3492@end table
3493
6d2ebf8b 3494@node Signals
c906108c
SS
3495@section Signals
3496@cindex signals
3497
3498A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3499operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3500kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
d4f3574e 3501signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
c906108c
SS
3502@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3503memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3504the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3505requested an alarm).
3506
3507@cindex fatal signals
3508Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3509functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
d4f3574e 3510errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
c906108c
SS
3511program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3512@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3513fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3514
3515@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3516program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3517signal.
3518
3519@cindex handling signals
24f93129
EZ
3520Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3521@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3522(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
c906108c
SS
3523but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3524You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3525
3526@table @code
3527@kindex info signals
3528@item info signals
96a2c332 3529@itemx info handle
c906108c
SS
3530Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3531handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3532the defined types of signals.
3533
d4f3574e 3534@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
c906108c
SS
3535
3536@kindex handle
3537@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
5ece1a18
EZ
3538Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3539can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
24f93129 3540@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5ece1a18
EZ
3541@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3542known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
c906108c
SS
3543@end table
3544
3545@c @group
3546The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3547Their full names are:
3548
3549@table @code
3550@item nostop
3551@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3552still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3553
3554@item stop
3555@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3556the @code{print} keyword as well.
3557
3558@item print
3559@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3560
3561@item noprint
3562@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3563implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3564
3565@item pass
5ece1a18 3566@itemx noignore
c906108c
SS
3567@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3568can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5ece1a18 3569and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3570
3571@item nopass
5ece1a18 3572@itemx ignore
c906108c 3573@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5ece1a18 3574@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3575@end table
3576@c @end group
3577
d4f3574e
SS
3578When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3579program until you
c906108c
SS
3580continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3581effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3582after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3583command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3584program sees that signal when you continue.
3585
24f93129
EZ
3586The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3587non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3588@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3589erroneous signals.
3590
c906108c
SS
3591You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3592seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3593or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3594due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3595values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3596execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3597a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3598you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5d161b24 3599program a signal}.
c906108c 3600
6d2ebf8b 3601@node Thread Stops
c906108c
SS
3602@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3603
3604When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3605programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3606breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3607
3608@table @code
3609@cindex breakpoints and threads
3610@cindex thread breakpoints
3611@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3612@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3613@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3614@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3615writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3616
3617Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3618to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3619particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3620numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3621column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3622
3623If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3624breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3625program.
3626
3627You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3628well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3629breakpoint condition, like this:
3630
3631@smallexample
2df3850c 3632(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
c906108c
SS
3633@end smallexample
3634
3635@end table
3636
3637@cindex stopped threads
3638@cindex threads, stopped
3639Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3640@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3641allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3642switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3643underfoot.
3644
3645@cindex continuing threads
3646@cindex threads, continuing
3647Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3648executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5d161b24 3649like @code{step} or @code{next}.
c906108c
SS
3650
3651In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3652Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3653system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3654execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3655single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3656statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3657stops.
3658
3659You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3660continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3661thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3662first thread completes whatever you requested.
3663
3664On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3665thread to run.
3666
3667@table @code
3668@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3669Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3670locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3671current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3672mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3673``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3674stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
d4f3574e 3675when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
c906108c 3676function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
d4f3574e 3677like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
c906108c 3678thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
2df3850c 3679@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
c906108c
SS
3680
3681@item show scheduler-locking
3682Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3683@end table
3684
c906108c 3685
6d2ebf8b 3686@node Stack
c906108c
SS
3687@chapter Examining the Stack
3688
3689When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3690stopped and how it got there.
3691
3692@cindex call stack
5d161b24
DB
3693Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3694is generated.
3695That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3696the arguments of the call,
c906108c 3697and the local variables of the function being called.
5d161b24 3698The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
c906108c
SS
3699The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3700stack}.
3701
3702When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3703stack allow you to see all of this information.
3704
3705@cindex selected frame
3706One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3707@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3708particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3709your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3710special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3711interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3712
3713When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5d161b24 3714currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
c906108c
SS
3715@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3716
3717@menu
3718* Frames:: Stack frames
3719* Backtrace:: Backtraces
3720* Selection:: Selecting a frame
3721* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
c906108c
SS
3722
3723@end menu
3724
6d2ebf8b 3725@node Frames
c906108c
SS
3726@section Stack frames
3727
d4f3574e 3728@cindex frame, definition
c906108c
SS
3729@cindex stack frame
3730The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3731frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3732with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3733to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3734which the function is executing.
3735
3736@cindex initial frame
3737@cindex outermost frame
3738@cindex innermost frame
3739When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3740function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3741@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3742made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3743is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3744the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3745actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3746recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3747
3748@cindex frame pointer
3749Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3750stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3751kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3752address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3753in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3754going on in that frame.
3755
3756@cindex frame number
3757@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3758zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3759and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3760they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3761frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3762
6d2ebf8b
SS
3763@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3764@c underflow problems.
c906108c
SS
3765@cindex frameless execution
3766Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6d2ebf8b 3767without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
474c8240 3768@smallexample
6d2ebf8b 3769@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
474c8240 3770@end smallexample
6d2ebf8b 3771generates functions without a frame.)
c906108c
SS
3772This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3773the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3774with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3775has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3776it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3777correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3778no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3779
3780@table @code
d4f3574e 3781@kindex frame@r{, command}
41afff9a 3782@cindex current stack frame
c906108c 3783@item frame @var{args}
5d161b24 3784The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
c906108c 3785and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5d161b24
DB
3786address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3787@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
c906108c
SS
3788
3789@kindex select-frame
41afff9a 3790@cindex selecting frame silently
c906108c
SS
3791@item select-frame
3792The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3793to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3794@code{frame}.
3795@end table
3796
6d2ebf8b 3797@node Backtrace
c906108c
SS
3798@section Backtraces
3799
3800@cindex backtraces
3801@cindex tracebacks
3802@cindex stack traces
3803A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3804line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3805frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3806stack.
3807
3808@table @code
3809@kindex backtrace
41afff9a 3810@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
c906108c
SS
3811@item backtrace
3812@itemx bt
3813Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3814frames in the stack.
3815
3816You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3817character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3818
3819@item backtrace @var{n}
3820@itemx bt @var{n}
3821Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3822
3823@item backtrace -@var{n}
3824@itemx bt -@var{n}
3825Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3826@end table
3827
3828@kindex where
3829@kindex info stack
41afff9a 3830@kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
c906108c
SS
3831The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3832are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3833
3834Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3835The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3836print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3837line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3838counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3839line number.
3840
3841Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3842@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3843
3844@smallexample
3845@group
5d161b24 3846#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
c906108c
SS
3847 at builtin.c:993
3848#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3849#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3850 at macro.c:71
3851(More stack frames follow...)
3852@end group
3853@end smallexample
3854
3855@noindent
3856The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3857value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3858code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3859
6d2ebf8b 3860@node Selection
c906108c
SS
3861@section Selecting a frame
3862
3863Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3864whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3865selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3866of the stack frame just selected.
3867
3868@table @code
d4f3574e 3869@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
41afff9a 3870@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
c906108c
SS
3871@item frame @var{n}
3872@itemx f @var{n}
3873Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3874(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3875innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3876@code{main}.
3877
3878@item frame @var{addr}
3879@itemx f @var{addr}
3880Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3881chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3882impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3883addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3884switches between them.
3885
c906108c
SS
3886On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3887select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3888
3889On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3890pointer and a program counter.
3891
3892On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3893pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3894@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3895@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3896@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
c906108c
SS
3897
3898@kindex up
3899@item up @var{n}
3900Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3901advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3902that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3903
3904@kindex down
41afff9a 3905@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
c906108c
SS
3906@item down @var{n}
3907Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3908advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3909that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3910abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3911@end table
3912
3913All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3914frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3915arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5d161b24 3916frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
c906108c
SS
3917
3918@need 1000
3919For example:
3920
3921@smallexample
3922@group
3923(@value{GDBP}) up
3924#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3925 at env.c:10
392610 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3927@end group
3928@end smallexample
3929
3930After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3931prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
87885426
FN
3932You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
3933editing program by typing @code{edit}.
3934@xref{List, ,Printing source lines},
3935for details.
c906108c
SS
3936
3937@table @code
3938@kindex down-silently
3939@kindex up-silently
3940@item up-silently @var{n}
3941@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3942These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3943respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3944causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3945in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3946distracting.
3947@end table
3948
6d2ebf8b 3949@node Frame Info
c906108c
SS
3950@section Information about a frame
3951
3952There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3953stack frame.
3954
3955@table @code
3956@item frame
3957@itemx f
3958When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3959frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3960selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3961argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3962@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3963
3964@kindex info frame
41afff9a 3965@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
c906108c
SS
3966@item info frame
3967@itemx info f
3968This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3969including:
3970
3971@itemize @bullet
5d161b24
DB
3972@item
3973the address of the frame
c906108c
SS
3974@item
3975the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3976@item
3977the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3978@item
3979the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3980@item
3981the address of the frame's arguments
3982@item
d4f3574e
SS
3983the address of the frame's local variables
3984@item
c906108c
SS
3985the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3986@item
3987which registers were saved in the frame
3988@end itemize
3989
3990@noindent The verbose description is useful when
3991something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3992the usual conventions.
3993
3994@item info frame @var{addr}
3995@itemx info f @var{addr}
3996Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3997selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3998command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3999architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4000@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4001
4002@kindex info args
4003@item info args
4004Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4005
4006@item info locals
4007@kindex info locals
4008Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4009line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4010accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4011
c906108c 4012@kindex info catch
d4f3574e
SS
4013@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4014@cindex exception handlers, how to list
c906108c
SS
4015@item info catch
4016Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4017current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4018exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4019@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4020@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
53a5351d 4021
c906108c
SS
4022@end table
4023
c906108c 4024
6d2ebf8b 4025@node Source
c906108c
SS
4026@chapter Examining Source Files
4027
4028@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4029information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4030used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4031the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4032(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4033execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4034source files by explicit command.
4035
7a292a7a 4036If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
d4f3574e 4037prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7a292a7a 4038@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
c906108c
SS
4039
4040@menu
4041* List:: Printing source lines
87885426 4042* Edit:: Editing source files
c906108c 4043* Search:: Searching source files
c906108c
SS
4044* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4045* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4046@end menu
4047
6d2ebf8b 4048@node List
c906108c
SS
4049@section Printing source lines
4050
4051@kindex list
41afff9a 4052@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
c906108c 4053To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5d161b24 4054(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
c906108c
SS
4055There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4056
4057Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4058
4059@table @code
4060@item list @var{linenum}
4061Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4062current source file.
4063
4064@item list @var{function}
4065Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4066@var{function}.
4067
4068@item list
4069Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4070@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4071printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4072as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4073Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4074
4075@item list -
4076Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4077@end table
4078
4079By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4080the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4081
4082@table @code
4083@kindex set listsize
4084@item set listsize @var{count}
4085Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4086the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4087
4088@kindex show listsize
4089@item show listsize
4090Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4091@end table
4092
4093Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4094so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4095than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4096argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4097each repetition moves up in the source file.
4098
4099@cindex linespec
4100In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4101@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
d4f3574e 4102of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
c906108c
SS
4103Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4104
4105@table @code
4106@item list @var{linespec}
4107Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4108
4109@item list @var{first},@var{last}
4110Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4111linespecs.
4112
4113@item list ,@var{last}
4114Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4115
4116@item list @var{first},
4117Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4118
4119@item list +
4120Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4121
4122@item list -
4123Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4124
4125@item list
4126As described in the preceding table.
4127@end table
4128
4129Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4130kinds of linespec.
4131
4132@table @code
4133@item @var{number}
4134Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4135When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4136the same source file as the first linespec.
4137
4138@item +@var{offset}
4139Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4140When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4141two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4142first linespec.
4143
4144@item -@var{offset}
4145Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4146
4147@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4148Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4149
4150@item @var{function}
4151Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4152For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4153
4154@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4155Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4156function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4157file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4158identically named functions in different source files.
4159
4160@item *@var{address}
4161Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4162@var{address} may be any expression.
4163@end table
4164
87885426
FN
4165@node Edit
4166@section Editing source files
4167@cindex editing source files
4168
4169@kindex edit
4170@kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4171To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4172The editing program of your choice
4173is invoked with the current line set to
4174the active line in the program.
4175Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4176want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4177
4178Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
4179
4180@table @code
4181@item edit
4182Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
4183
4184@item edit @var{number}
4185Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
4186
4187@item edit @var{function}
4188Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
4189
4190@item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
4191Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4192
4193@item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
4194Specifies the line that begins the body of the
4195function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4196file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4197identically named functions in different source files.
4198
4199@item edit *@var{address}
4200Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4201@var{address} may be any expression.
4202@end table
4203
4204@subsection Choosing your editor
4205You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
4206@footnote{
4207The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
4208following command-line syntax:
10998722 4209@smallexample
87885426 4210ex +@var{number} file
10998722
AC
4211@end smallexample
4212The optional numeric value +@var{number} designates the active line in
4213the file.}. By default, it is @value{EDITOR}, but you can change this
4214by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
4215@value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
4216@code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
4217@smallexample
87885426
FN
4218EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
4219export EDITOR
4220gdb ...
10998722 4221@end smallexample
87885426 4222or in the @code{csh} shell,
10998722 4223@smallexample
87885426
FN
4224setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
4225gdb ...
10998722 4226@end smallexample
87885426 4227
6d2ebf8b 4228@node Search
c906108c
SS
4229@section Searching source files
4230@cindex searching
4231@kindex reverse-search
4232
4233There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4234regular expression.
4235
4236@table @code
4237@kindex search
4238@kindex forward-search
4239@item forward-search @var{regexp}
4240@itemx search @var{regexp}
4241The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4242starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5d161b24 4243@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
c906108c
SS
4244synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4245@code{fo}.
4246
4247@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4248The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4249with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4250for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4251this command as @code{rev}.
4252@end table
c906108c 4253
6d2ebf8b 4254@node Source Path
c906108c
SS
4255@section Specifying source directories
4256
4257@cindex source path
4258@cindex directories for source files
4259Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4260files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4261the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4262session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4263this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4264it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4265in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4266the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4267the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4268path.
4269
4270If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4271object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4272too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4273compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4274last resort.
4275
4276Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4277any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4278each line is in the file.
4279
4280@kindex directory
4281@kindex dir
d4f3574e
SS
4282When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4283and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
c906108c
SS
4284To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4285
4286@table @code
4287@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4288@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4289Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
d4f3574e
SS
4290directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4291(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4292part of absolute file names) or
c906108c
SS
4293whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4294path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4295
4296@kindex cdir
4297@kindex cwd
41afff9a
EZ
4298@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4299@vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
4300@cindex compilation directory
4301@cindex current directory
4302@cindex working directory
4303@cindex directory, current
4304@cindex directory, compilation
4305You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4306directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4307working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4308tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4309session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4310directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4311
4312@item directory
4313Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4314
4315@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4316@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4317
4318@item show directories
4319@kindex show directories
4320Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4321@end table
4322
4323If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4324interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4325versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4326
4327@enumerate
4328@item
4329Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4330
4331@item
4332Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4333directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4334directories in one command.
4335@end enumerate
4336
6d2ebf8b 4337@node Machine Code
c906108c
SS
4338@section Source and machine code
4339
4340You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4341addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4342a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d4f3574e 4343mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5d161b24 4344line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
c906108c
SS
4345well as hex.
4346
4347@table @code
4348@kindex info line
4349@item info line @var{linespec}
4350Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4351source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4352the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4353source lines}).
4354@end table
4355
4356For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4357the object code for the first line of function
4358@code{m4_changequote}:
4359
d4f3574e
SS
4360@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4361@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
c906108c 4362@smallexample
96a2c332 4363(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
c906108c
SS
4364Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4365@end smallexample
4366
4367@noindent
4368We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4369@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4370@smallexample
4371(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4372Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4373@end smallexample
4374
4375@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
41afff9a 4376@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
c906108c
SS
4377After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4378is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4379sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4380,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4381convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4382variables}).
4383
4384@table @code
4385@kindex disassemble
4386@cindex assembly instructions
4387@cindex instructions, assembly
4388@cindex machine instructions
4389@cindex listing machine instructions
4390@item disassemble
4391This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4392instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4393program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4394command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4395surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4396(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4397@end table
4398
c906108c
SS
4399The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4400HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4401
4402@smallexample
4403(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4404Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
44050x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
44060x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
44070x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
44080x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
44090x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
44100x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
44110x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
44120x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4413End of assembler dump.
4414@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4415
4416Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4417mnemonics or other syntax.
4418
4419@table @code
d4f3574e 4420@kindex set disassembly-flavor
c906108c
SS
4421@cindex assembly instructions
4422@cindex instructions, assembly
4423@cindex machine instructions
4424@cindex listing machine instructions
d4f3574e
SS
4425@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4426@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4427@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
c906108c
SS
4428Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4429program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4430
4431Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
d4f3574e
SS
4432can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4433The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4434assemblers for x86-based targets.
c906108c
SS
4435@end table
4436
4437
6d2ebf8b 4438@node Data
c906108c
SS
4439@chapter Examining Data
4440
4441@cindex printing data
4442@cindex examining data
4443@kindex print
4444@kindex inspect
4445@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4446@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4447@c different window or something like that.
4448The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7a292a7a
SS
4449command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4450evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4451program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4452Different Languages}).
c906108c
SS
4453
4454@table @code
d4f3574e
SS
4455@item print @var{expr}
4456@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4457@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4458value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
c906108c 4459you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
d4f3574e 4460@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
c906108c
SS
4461formats}.
4462
4463@item print
4464@itemx print /@var{f}
d4f3574e 4465If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
c906108c
SS
4466@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4467conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4468@end table
4469
4470A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4471It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4472specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4473
7a292a7a 4474If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
d4f3574e
SS
4475fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4476command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7a292a7a 4477Table}.
c906108c
SS
4478
4479@menu
4480* Expressions:: Expressions
4481* Variables:: Program variables
4482* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4483* Output Formats:: Output formats
4484* Memory:: Examining memory
4485* Auto Display:: Automatic display
4486* Print Settings:: Print settings
4487* Value History:: Value history
4488* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4489* Registers:: Registers
c906108c 4490* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
53c69bd7 4491* Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
29e57380 4492* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
16d9dec6 4493* Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
a0eb71c5
KB
4494* Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
4495 character set than GDB does
c906108c
SS
4496@end menu
4497
6d2ebf8b 4498@node Expressions
c906108c
SS
4499@section Expressions
4500
4501@cindex expressions
4502@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4503compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4504by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
e2e0bcd1
JB
4505@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
4506casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
4507you compiled your program to include this information; see
4508@ref{Compilation}.
c906108c 4509
d4f3574e
SS
4510@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4511the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5d161b24 4512you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
d4f3574e 4513memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
c906108c 4514
c906108c
SS
4515Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4516this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4517Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4518languages.
4519
4520In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4521expressions regardless of your programming language.
4522
4523Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4524useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4525at that address in memory.
4526@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
c906108c
SS
4527
4528@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4529to programming languages:
4530
4531@table @code
4532@item @@
4533@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4534@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4535
4536@item ::
4537@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4538function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4539
4540@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4541@cindex type casting memory
4542@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4543@cindex casts, to view memory
4544@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4545Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4546memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4547pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4548a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4549normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4550@end table
4551
6d2ebf8b 4552@node Variables
c906108c
SS
4553@section Program variables
4554
4555The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4556in your program.
4557
4558Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4559(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4560
4561@itemize @bullet
4562@item
4563global (or file-static)
4564@end itemize
4565
5d161b24 4566@noindent or
c906108c
SS
4567
4568@itemize @bullet
4569@item
4570visible according to the scope rules of the
4571programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5d161b24 4572@end itemize
c906108c
SS
4573
4574@noindent This means that in the function
4575
474c8240 4576@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4577foo (a)
4578 int a;
4579@{
4580 bar (a);
4581 @{
4582 int b = test ();
4583 bar (b);
4584 @}
4585@}
474c8240 4586@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4587
4588@noindent
4589you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4590executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4591examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4592the block where @code{b} is declared.
4593
4594@cindex variable name conflict
4595There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4596scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4597in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4598function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4599happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4600you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4601using the colon-colon notation:
4602
d4f3574e 4603@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4604@iftex
4605@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
41afff9a 4606@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
c906108c 4607@end iftex
474c8240 4608@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4609@var{file}::@var{variable}
4610@var{function}::@var{variable}
474c8240 4611@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4612
4613@noindent
4614Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4615static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4616make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4617to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4618
474c8240 4619@smallexample
c906108c 4620(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
474c8240 4621@end smallexample
c906108c 4622
b37052ae 4623@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
c906108c 4624This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
b37052ae 4625use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
4626scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4627@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4628@c conflict?? --mew
c906108c
SS
4629
4630@cindex wrong values
4631@cindex variable values, wrong
4632@quotation
4633@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4634wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4635scope, and just before exit.
4636@end quotation
4637You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4638This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4639set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4640stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4641values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4642also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4643after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4644variable definitions may be gone.
4645
4646This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4647To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4648when compiling.
4649
d4f3574e
SS
4650@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4651Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4652unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4653opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4654offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4655might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4656happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4657
474c8240 4658@smallexample
d4f3574e 4659No symbol "foo" in current context.
474c8240 4660@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
4661
4662To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4663different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
b37052ae 4664formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler usually
d4f3574e
SS
4665supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4666in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
96c405b3 4667to use DWARF2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
d4f3574e
SS
4668debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4669Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4670information.
4671
4672
6d2ebf8b 4673@node Arrays
c906108c
SS
4674@section Artificial arrays
4675
4676@cindex artificial array
41afff9a 4677@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
c906108c
SS
4678It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4679same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4680dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4681program.
4682
4683You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4684@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4685operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4686and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4687of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4688the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4689argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4690following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4691example. If a program says
4692
474c8240 4693@smallexample
c906108c 4694int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
474c8240 4695@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4696
4697@noindent
4698you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4699
474c8240 4700@smallexample
c906108c 4701p *array@@len
474c8240 4702@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4703
4704The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4705with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4706subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4707Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4708(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4709
4710Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4711This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4712The value need not be in memory:
474c8240 4713@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4714(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4715$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
474c8240 4716@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4717
4718As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
c3f6f71d 4719@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
c906108c 4720the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
474c8240 4721@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4722(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4723$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
474c8240 4724@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4725
4726Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4727moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4728actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4729of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4730to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4731variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4732interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4733instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4734structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4735in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4736
474c8240 4737@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4738set $i = 0
4739p dtab[$i++]->fv
4740@key{RET}
4741@key{RET}
4742@dots{}
474c8240 4743@end smallexample
c906108c 4744
6d2ebf8b 4745@node Output Formats
c906108c
SS
4746@section Output formats
4747
4748@cindex formatted output
4749@cindex output formats
4750By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4751this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4752in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4753at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4754these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4755
4756The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4757already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4758@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4759letters supported are:
4760
4761@table @code
4762@item x
4763Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4764hexadecimal.
4765
4766@item d
4767Print as integer in signed decimal.
4768
4769@item u
4770Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4771
4772@item o
4773Print as integer in octal.
4774
4775@item t
4776Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4777@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4778used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
d4f3574e 4779see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
c906108c
SS
4780
4781@item a
4782@cindex unknown address, locating
3d67e040 4783@cindex locate address
c906108c
SS
4784Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4785the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4786where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4787
474c8240 4788@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4789(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4790$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
474c8240 4791@end smallexample
c906108c 4792
3d67e040
EZ
4793@noindent
4794The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4795@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4796
c906108c
SS
4797@item c
4798Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4799
4800@item f
4801Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4802using typical floating point syntax.
4803@end table
4804
4805For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4806
474c8240 4807@smallexample
c906108c 4808p/x $pc
474c8240 4809@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4810
4811@noindent
4812Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4813names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4814
4815To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4816you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4817expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4818
6d2ebf8b 4819@node Memory
c906108c
SS
4820@section Examining memory
4821
4822You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4823any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4824
4825@cindex examining memory
4826@table @code
41afff9a 4827@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
c906108c
SS
4828@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4829@itemx x @var{addr}
4830@itemx x
4831Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4832@end table
4833
4834@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4835much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4836expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4837If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4838Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4839
4840@table @r
4841@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4842The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4843how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4844@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4845@c 4.1.2.
4846
4847@item @var{f}, the display format
4848The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4849@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4850The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4851The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4852
4853@item @var{u}, the unit size
4854The unit size is any of
4855
4856@table @code
4857@item b
4858Bytes.
4859@item h
4860Halfwords (two bytes).
4861@item w
4862Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4863@item g
4864Giant words (eight bytes).
4865@end table
4866
4867Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4868default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4869@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4870
4871@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4872@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4873memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4874it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4875@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4876@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4877other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4878the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4879starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4880a value from memory).
4881@end table
4882
4883For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4884(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4885starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4886words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
d4f3574e 4887@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
c906108c
SS
4888
4889Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4890letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4891unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4892specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4893(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4894
4895Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4896and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4897@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4898including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
d4f3574e 4899alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
c906108c
SS
4900Code,,Source and machine code}.
4901
4902All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4903easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4904you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4905instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4906with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4907the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4908for successive uses of @code{x}.
4909
4910@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4911The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4912in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4913would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4914subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4915@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4916examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4917@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4918the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4919
4920If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4921are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4922address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4923
6d2ebf8b 4924@node Auto Display
c906108c
SS
4925@section Automatic display
4926@cindex automatic display
4927@cindex display of expressions
4928
4929If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4930(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4931display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4932Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4933to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4934The automatic display looks like this:
4935
474c8240 4936@smallexample
c906108c
SS
49372: foo = 38
49383: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
474c8240 4939@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4940
4941@noindent
4942This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4943displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4944specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4945whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4946format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4947or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4948supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4949
4950@table @code
4951@kindex display
d4f3574e
SS
4952@item display @var{expr}
4953Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
c906108c
SS
4954each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4955
4956@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4957
d4f3574e 4958@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
c906108c 4959For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
d4f3574e 4960count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
c906108c
SS
4961arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4962@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4963
4964@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4965For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4966number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4967be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4968doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4969@end table
4970
4971For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4972instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
d4f3574e 4973is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
4974
4975@table @code
4976@kindex delete display
4977@kindex undisplay
4978@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4979@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4980Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4981
4982@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4983(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4984
4985@kindex disable display
4986@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4987Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
4988item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
4989enabled again later.
4990
4991@kindex enable display
4992@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4993Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
4994again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4995
4996@item display
4997Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4998done when your program stops.
4999
5000@kindex info display
5001@item info display
5002Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5003automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
5004values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
5005It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
5006because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
5007@end table
5008
5009If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
5010sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
5011expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
5012variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
5013@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
5014@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
5015continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
5016there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
5017automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
5018is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
5019
6d2ebf8b 5020@node Print Settings
c906108c
SS
5021@section Print settings
5022
5023@cindex format options
5024@cindex print settings
5025@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
5026and symbols are printed.
5027
5028@noindent
5029These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
5030
5031@table @code
5032@kindex set print address
5033@item set print address
5034@itemx set print address on
5035@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
5036traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
5037even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
5038is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
5039@code{set print address on}:
5040
5041@smallexample
5042@group
5043(@value{GDBP}) f
5044#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
5045 at input.c:530
5046530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5047@end group
5048@end smallexample
5049
5050@item set print address off
5051Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
5052this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
5053
5054@smallexample
5055@group
5056(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
5057(@value{GDBP}) f
5058#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
5059530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5060@end group
5061@end smallexample
5062
5063You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
5064dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
5065@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
5066all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
5067
5068@kindex show print address
5069@item show print address
5070Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
5071@end table
5072
5073When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
5074closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
5075identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
5076source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
5077@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
5078you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
5079it prints a symbolic address:
5080
5081@table @code
5082@kindex set print symbol-filename
5083@item set print symbol-filename on
5084Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
5085symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5086
5087@item set print symbol-filename off
5088Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
5089default.
5090
5091@kindex show print symbol-filename
5092@item show print symbol-filename
5093Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
5094line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5095@end table
5096
5097Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
5098numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
5099number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
5100
5101Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
5102printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
5103
5104@table @code
5105@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
5106@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
5107Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
5108offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5d161b24 5109@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
5110to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
5111
5112@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
5113@item show print max-symbolic-offset
5114Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
5115symbolic address.
5116@end table
5117
5118@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
5119@cindex pointer, finding referent
5120If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
5121@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
5122and source file location of the variable where it points, using
5123@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
5124For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
5125at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
5126
474c8240 5127@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5128(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
5129(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
5130$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
474c8240 5131@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5132
5133@quotation
5134@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5135does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5136the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5137@end quotation
5138
5139Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5140
5141@table @code
5142@kindex set print array
5143@item set print array
5144@itemx set print array on
5145Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5146but uses more space. The default is off.
5147
5148@item set print array off
5149Return to compressed format for arrays.
5150
5151@kindex show print array
5152@item show print array
5153Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5154arrays.
5155
5156@kindex set print elements
5157@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5158Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5159If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5160printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5161This limit also applies to the display of strings.
d4f3574e 5162When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
c906108c
SS
5163Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5164
5165@kindex show print elements
5166@item show print elements
5167Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5168If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5169
5170@kindex set print null-stop
5171@item set print null-stop
5172Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
d4f3574e 5173@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
c906108c 5174contain only short strings.
d4f3574e 5175The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5176
5177@kindex set print pretty
5178@item set print pretty on
5d161b24 5179Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
c906108c
SS
5180per line, like this:
5181
5182@smallexample
5183@group
5184$1 = @{
5185 next = 0x0,
5186 flags = @{
5187 sweet = 1,
5188 sour = 1
5189 @},
5190 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5191@}
5192@end group
5193@end smallexample
5194
5195@item set print pretty off
5196Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5197
5198@smallexample
5199@group
5200$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5201meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5202@end group
5203@end smallexample
5204
5205@noindent
5206This is the default format.
5207
5208@kindex show print pretty
5209@item show print pretty
5210Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5211
5212@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5213@item set print sevenbit-strings on
5214Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5215@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5216character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5217best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5218high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5219
5220@item set print sevenbit-strings off
5221Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5222international character sets, and is the default.
5223
5224@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5225@item show print sevenbit-strings
5226Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5227
5228@kindex set print union
5229@item set print union on
5d161b24 5230Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
c906108c
SS
5231is the default setting.
5232
5233@item set print union off
5234Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5235
5236@kindex show print union
5237@item show print union
5238Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5239structures.
5240
5241For example, given the declarations
5242
5243@smallexample
5244typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5245typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5d161b24 5246typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
c906108c
SS
5247 Bug_forms;
5248
5249struct thing @{
5250 Species it;
5251 union @{
5252 Tree_forms tree;
5253 Bug_forms bug;
5254 @} form;
5255@};
5256
5257struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5258@end smallexample
5259
5260@noindent
5261with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5262
5263@smallexample
5264$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5265@end smallexample
5266
5267@noindent
5268and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5269
5270@smallexample
5271$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5272@end smallexample
5273@end table
5274
c906108c
SS
5275@need 1000
5276@noindent
b37052ae 5277These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
c906108c
SS
5278
5279@table @code
5280@cindex demangling
5281@kindex set print demangle
5282@item set print demangle
5283@itemx set print demangle on
b37052ae 5284Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
c906108c 5285(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
d4f3574e 5286linkage. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5287
5288@kindex show print demangle
5289@item show print demangle
b37052ae 5290Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
c906108c
SS
5291
5292@kindex set print asm-demangle
5293@item set print asm-demangle
5294@itemx set print asm-demangle on
b37052ae 5295Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
c906108c
SS
5296in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5297The default is off.
5298
5299@kindex show print asm-demangle
5300@item show print asm-demangle
b37052ae 5301Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
c906108c
SS
5302or demangled form.
5303
5304@kindex set demangle-style
b37052ae
EZ
5305@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5306@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
5307@item set demangle-style @var{style}
5308Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
b37052ae 5309represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
c906108c
SS
5310
5311@table @code
5312@item auto
5313Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5314
5315@item gnu
b37052ae 5316Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c 5317This is the default.
c906108c
SS
5318
5319@item hp
b37052ae 5320Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5321
5322@item lucid
b37052ae 5323Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5324
5325@item arm
b37052ae 5326Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
c906108c
SS
5327@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5328debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5329require further enhancement to permit that.
5330
5331@end table
5332If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5333
5334@kindex show demangle-style
5335@item show demangle-style
b37052ae 5336Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
c906108c
SS
5337
5338@kindex set print object
5339@item set print object
5340@itemx set print object on
5341When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5342(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5343the virtual function table.
5344
5345@item set print object off
5346Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5347virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5348
5349@kindex show print object
5350@item show print object
5351Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5352
5353@kindex set print static-members
5354@item set print static-members
5355@itemx set print static-members on
b37052ae 5356Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5357
5358@item set print static-members off
b37052ae 5359Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
c906108c
SS
5360
5361@kindex show print static-members
5362@item show print static-members
b37052ae 5363Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
c906108c
SS
5364
5365@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5366@kindex set print vtbl
5367@item set print vtbl
5368@itemx set print vtbl on
b37052ae 5369Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
c906108c 5370(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 5371ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
5372
5373@item set print vtbl off
b37052ae 5374Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
c906108c
SS
5375
5376@kindex show print vtbl
5377@item show print vtbl
b37052ae 5378Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
c906108c 5379@end table
c906108c 5380
6d2ebf8b 5381@node Value History
c906108c
SS
5382@section Value history
5383
5384@cindex value history
5d161b24
DB
5385Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5386@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5387Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5388(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5389When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5390since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
c906108c
SS
5391symbol table.
5392
5393@cindex @code{$}
5394@cindex @code{$$}
5395@cindex history number
5396The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5397refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5398@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5399printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5400history number.
5401
5402To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5403history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5404remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5405the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5406@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5407is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5408@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5409
5410For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5411want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5412
474c8240 5413@smallexample
c906108c 5414p *$
474c8240 5415@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5416
5417If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5418to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5419
474c8240 5420@smallexample
c906108c 5421p *$.next
474c8240 5422@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5423
5424@noindent
5425You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5426command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5427
5428Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5429@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5430
474c8240 5431@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5432print x
5433set x=5
474c8240 5434@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5435
5436@noindent
5437then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5438remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5439
5440@table @code
5441@kindex show values
5442@item show values
5443Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5444This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5445values} does not change the history.
5446
5447@item show values @var{n}
5448Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5449
5450@item show values +
5451Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5452values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5453@end table
5454
5455Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5456same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5457
6d2ebf8b 5458@node Convenience Vars
c906108c
SS
5459@section Convenience variables
5460
5461@cindex convenience variables
5462@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5463@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5464exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5465setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5466of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5467
5468Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5469@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
d4f3574e 5470the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5471(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5472by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5473
5474You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5475expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5476For example:
5477
474c8240 5478@smallexample
c906108c 5479set $foo = *object_ptr
474c8240 5480@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5481
5482@noindent
5483would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5484@code{object_ptr}.
5485
5486Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5487value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5488value with another assignment at any time.
5489
5490Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5491variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5492that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5493variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5494
5495@table @code
5496@kindex show convenience
5497@item show convenience
5498Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
d4f3574e 5499Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
c906108c
SS
5500@end table
5501
5502One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5503incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5504a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5505
474c8240 5506@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5507set $i = 0
5508print bar[$i++]->contents
474c8240 5509@end smallexample
c906108c 5510
d4f3574e
SS
5511@noindent
5512Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
c906108c
SS
5513
5514Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5515values likely to be useful.
5516
5517@table @code
41afff9a 5518@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5519@item $_
5520The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5521the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5522commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5523set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5524and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5525except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5526to the type of @code{$__}.
5527
41afff9a 5528@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5529@item $__
5530The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5531to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5532to match the format in which the data was printed.
5533
5534@item $_exitcode
41afff9a 5535@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5536The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5537the program being debugged terminates.
5538@end table
5539
53a5351d
JM
5540On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5541begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5542name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
c906108c 5543
6d2ebf8b 5544@node Registers
c906108c
SS
5545@section Registers
5546
5547@cindex registers
5548You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5549with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5550for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5551your machine.
5552
5553@table @code
5554@kindex info registers
5555@item info registers
5556Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
c85508ee 5557and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
c906108c
SS
5558
5559@kindex info all-registers
5560@cindex floating point registers
5561@item info all-registers
5562Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
c85508ee 5563and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
c906108c
SS
5564
5565@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5566Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5d161b24
DB
5567As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5568the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
c906108c
SS
5569the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5570@end table
5571
5572@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5573expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5574architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5575@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5576the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5577pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5578register that contains the processor status. For example,
5579you could print the program counter in hex with
5580
474c8240 5581@smallexample
c906108c 5582p/x $pc
474c8240 5583@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5584
5585@noindent
5586or print the instruction to be executed next with
5587
474c8240 5588@smallexample
c906108c 5589x/i $pc
474c8240 5590@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5591
5592@noindent
5593or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5594one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5595memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5596stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5597stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5598regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
d4f3574e 5599see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
c906108c 5600
474c8240 5601@smallexample
c906108c 5602set $sp += 4
474c8240 5603@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5604
5605Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5606your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5607so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5608shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5609registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
d4f3574e
SS
5610can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5611is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
c906108c
SS
5612
5613@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5614integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5615special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5616registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5617to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5618(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5619@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5620
5621Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5622means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5623the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5624sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5625coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5626programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5d161b24 5627cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
c906108c
SS
5628that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5629prints the data in both formats.
5630
5631Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5632(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5633value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5634were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5635true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5636frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5637
5638However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5639code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5640@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5641frame makes no difference.
5642
6d2ebf8b 5643@node Floating Point Hardware
c906108c
SS
5644@section Floating point hardware
5645@cindex floating point
5646
5647Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5648you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5649
5650@table @code
5651@kindex info float
5652@item info float
5653Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5654point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5655floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5656the ARM and x86 machines.
5657@end table
c906108c 5658
e76f1f2e
AC
5659@node Vector Unit
5660@section Vector Unit
5661@cindex vector unit
5662
5663Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
5664more information about the status of the vector unit.
5665
5666@table @code
5667@kindex info vector
5668@item info vector
5669Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
5670layout vary depending on the hardware.
5671@end table
5672
29e57380 5673@node Memory Region Attributes
16d9dec6 5674@section Memory region attributes
29e57380
C
5675@cindex memory region attributes
5676
5677@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5678required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5679to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5680use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5681
5682Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5683memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5684accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5685been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5686all memory.
5687
5688When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5689to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5690
5691@table @code
5692@kindex mem
bfac230e
DH
5693@item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5694Define memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
5695attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a
5696special case: it is treated as the the target's maximum memory address.
5697(0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
29e57380
C
5698
5699@kindex delete mem
5700@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5701Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5702
5703@kindex disable mem
5704@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5705Disable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5706A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5707It may be enabled again later.
5708
5709@kindex enable mem
5710@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5711Enable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5712
5713@kindex info mem
5714@item info mem
5715Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5716for each region.
5717
5718@table @emph
5719@item Memory Region Number
5720@item Enabled or Disabled.
5721Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5722Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5723
5724@item Lo Address
5725The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5726
5727@item Hi Address
5728The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5729
5730@item Attributes
5731The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5732@end table
5733@end table
5734
5735
5736@subsection Attributes
5737
5738@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5739The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5740write accesses to a memory region.
5741
5742While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5743memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5744etc. from accessing memory.
5745
5746@table @code
5747@item ro
5748Memory is read only.
5749@item wo
5750Memory is write only.
5751@item rw
6ca652b0 5752Memory is read/write. This is the default.
29e57380
C
5753@end table
5754
5755@subsubsection Memory Access Size
5756The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5757accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5758require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5759specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5760
5761@table @code
5762@item 8
5763Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5764@item 16
5765Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5766@item 32
5767Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5768@item 64
5769Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5770@end table
5771
5772@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5773@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5774@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5775@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5776@c
5777@c @table @code
5778@c @item hwbreak
5779@c Always use hardware breakpoints
5780@c @item swbreak (default)
5781@c @end table
5782
5783@subsubsection Data Cache
5784The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5785memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5786protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5787does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5788registers.
5789
5790@table @code
5791@item cache
5792Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
6ca652b0
EZ
5793@item nocache
5794Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
29e57380
C
5795@end table
5796
5797@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5798@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5799@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5800@c
5801@c @table @code
5802@c @item verify
5803@c @item noverify (default)
5804@c @end table
5805
16d9dec6
MS
5806@node Dump/Restore Files
5807@section Copy between memory and a file
5808@cindex dump/restore files
5809@cindex append data to a file
5810@cindex dump data to a file
5811@cindex restore data from a file
5812@kindex dump
5813@kindex append
5814@kindex restore
5815
5816The commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and @code{restore} are used
5817for copying data between target memory and a file. Data is written
5818into a file using @code{dump} or @code{append}, and restored from a
5819file into memory by using @code{restore}. Files may be binary, srec,
5820intel hex, or tekhex (but only binary files can be appended).
5821
5822@table @code
5823@kindex dump binary
5824@kindex append binary
5825@item dump binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5826Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5827raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5828
5829@item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5830Append contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} to
5831raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5832
5833@item dump binary value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5834Dump value of @var{expression} into raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5835
5836@item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{expression}
5837Append value of @var{expression} to raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5838
5839@kindex dump ihex
5840@item dump ihex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5841Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5842intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5843
5844@item dump ihex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5845Dump value of @var{expression} into intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5846
5847@kindex dump srec
5848@item dump srec memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5849Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5850srec format file @var{filename}.
5851
5852@item dump srec value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5853Dump value of @var{expression} into srec format file @var{filename}.
5854
5855@kindex dump tekhex
5856@item dump tekhex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5857Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5858tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5859
5860@item dump tekhex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5861Dump value of @var{expression} into tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5862
42f9b0a5 5863@item restore @var{filename} [@var{binary}] @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
16d9dec6
MS
5864Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The @code{restore}
5865command can automatically recognize any known bfd file format, except for
5866raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you must use the optional argument
5867@var{binary} after the filename.
5868
5869If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
5870contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
5871they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
5872a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
5873from that location.
5874
5875If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
5876file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
5877These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
5878the @var{bias} argument is applied.
5879
5880@end table
5881
a0eb71c5
KB
5882@node Character Sets
5883@section Character Sets
5884@cindex character sets
5885@cindex charset
5886@cindex translating between character sets
5887@cindex host character set
5888@cindex target character set
5889
5890If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
5891represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
5892@value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
5893you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
5894character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
5895@dfn{target character set}.
5896
5897For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
5898uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
5899remote protocol (@pxref{Remote,Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
5900running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
5901then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
5902@sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
5903target-charset ebcdic-us}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
5904@sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
5905character and string literals in expressions.
5906
5907@value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
5908the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
5909target-charset} command, described below.
5910
5911Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
5912support:
5913
5914@table @code
5915@item set target-charset @var{charset}
5916@kindex set target-charset
5917Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
5918character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you invoke the
5919@code{set target-charset} command with no argument, @value{GDBN} lists
5920the character sets it supports.
5921@end table
5922
5923@table @code
5924@item set host-charset @var{charset}
5925@kindex set host-charset
5926Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
5927
5928By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
5929system it is running on; you can override that default using the
5930@code{set host-charset} command.
5931
5932@value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
5933set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
5934indicate which can be host character sets, but if you invoke the
5935@code{set host-charset} command with no argument, @value{GDBN} lists the
5936character sets it supports, placing an asterisk (@samp{*}) after those
5937it can use as a host character set.
5938
5939@item set charset @var{charset}
5940@kindex set charset
5941Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. If you
5942invoke the @code{set charset} command with no argument, it lists the
5943character sets it supports. @value{GDBN} can only use certain character
5944sets as its host character set; it marks those in the list with an
5945asterisk (@samp{*}).
5946
5947@item show charset
5948@itemx show host-charset
5949@itemx show target-charset
5950@kindex show charset
5951@kindex show host-charset
5952@kindex show target-charset
5953Show the current host and target charsets. The @code{show host-charset}
5954and @code{show target-charset} commands are synonyms for @code{show
5955charset}.
5956
5957@end table
5958
5959@value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
5960sets:
5961
5962@table @code
5963
5964@item ASCII
5965@cindex ASCII character set
5966Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
5967character set.
5968
5969@item ISO-8859-1
5970@cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
5971@cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
5972The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends ASCII with accented
5973characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
5974this as its host character set.
5975
5976@item EBCDIC-US
5977@itemx IBM1047
5978@cindex EBCDIC character set
5979@cindex IBM1047 character set
5980Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
5981mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
5982@value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
5983
5984@end table
5985
5986Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
5987GDB is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
5988encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
5989
5990Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
5991Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
5992@file{charset-test.c}:
5993
5994@smallexample
5995#include <stdio.h>
5996
5997char ascii_hello[]
5998 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
5999 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
6000char ibm1047_hello[]
6001 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
6002 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
6003
6004main ()
6005@{
6006 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6007@}
10998722 6008@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6009
6010In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
6011containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
6012encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
6013
6014We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
6015
6016@smallexample
6017$ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
6018$ gdb -nw charset-test
6019GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
6020Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6021@dots{}
6022(gdb)
10998722 6023@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6024
6025We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
6026@value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
6027strings:
6028
6029@smallexample
6030(gdb) show charset
6031The current host and target character set is `iso-8859-1'.
6032(gdb)
10998722 6033@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6034
6035For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
6036initial character set:
6037@smallexample
6038(gdb) set charset ascii
6039(gdb) show charset
6040The current host and target character set is `ascii'.
6041(gdb)
10998722 6042@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6043
6044Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
6045host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
6046characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
6047them properly. Since our current target character set is also
6048@sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
6049
6050@smallexample
6051(gdb) print ascii_hello
6052$1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
6053(gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6054$2 = 72 'H'
6055(gdb)
10998722 6056@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6057
6058@value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
6059literals you use in expressions:
6060
6061@smallexample
6062(gdb) print '+'
6063$3 = 43 '+'
6064(gdb)
10998722 6065@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6066
6067The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
6068character.
6069
6070@value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
6071target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
6072character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
6073
6074@smallexample
6075(gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6076$4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
6077(gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6078$5 = 200 '\310'
6079(gdb)
10998722 6080@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6081
6082If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} command without an argument,
6083@value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
6084
6085@smallexample
6086(gdb) set target-charset
6087Valid character sets are:
6088 ascii *
6089 iso-8859-1 *
6090 ebcdic-us
6091 ibm1047
6092* - can be used as a host character set
10998722 6093@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6094
6095We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
6096program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
6097@value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
6098target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
6099@sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
6100
6101@smallexample
6102(gdb) set target-charset ibm1047
6103(gdb) show charset
6104The current host character set is `ascii'.
6105The current target character set is `ibm1047'.
6106(gdb) print ascii_hello
6107$6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
6108(gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6109$7 = 72 '\110'
6110(gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6111$8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
6112(gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6113$9 = 200 'H'
6114(gdb)
10998722 6115@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6116
6117As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
6118string literals you use in expressions:
6119
6120@smallexample
6121(gdb) print '+'
6122$10 = 78 '+'
6123(gdb)
10998722 6124@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6125
6126The IBM1047 character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
6127character.
6128
6129
e2e0bcd1
JB
6130@node Macros
6131@chapter C Preprocessor Macros
6132
6133Some languages, such as C and C++, provide a way to define and invoke
6134``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
6135@value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
6136the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
6137where it was defined.
6138
6139You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
6140with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
6141include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
6142with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
6143
6144A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
6145and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
6146points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
6147no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
6148uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
6149@value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
6150see @ref{List}.
6151
6152At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
6153token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
6154variable-arity macros.
6155
6156Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
6157macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
6158the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
6159
6160@table @code
6161
6162@kindex macro expand
6163@cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
6164@cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
6165@cindex expanding preprocessor macros
6166@item macro expand @var{expression}
6167@itemx macro exp @var{expression}
6168Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
6169@var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
6170not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
6171it can be any string of tokens.
6172
6173@kindex macro expand-once
6174@item macro expand-once @var{expression}
6175@itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
6176@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
6177expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
6178@var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
6179left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
6180particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
6181expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
6182parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
6183can be any string of tokens.
6184
475b0867 6185@kindex info macro
e2e0bcd1
JB
6186@cindex macro definition, showing
6187@cindex definition, showing a macro's
475b0867 6188@item info macro @var{macro}
e2e0bcd1
JB
6189Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
6190source location where that definition was established.
6191
6192@kindex macro define
6193@cindex user-defined macros
6194@cindex defining macros interactively
6195@cindex macros, user-defined
6196@item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
6197@itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
6198@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
6199preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
6200by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
6201command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
6202second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
6203given in @var{arglist}.
6204
6205A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
6206evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
6207undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
6208definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
6209well as any previous user-supplied definition.
6210
6211@kindex macro undef
6212@item macro undef @var{macro}
6213@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
6214definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
6215definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
6216above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
6217debugged.
6218
6219@end table
6220
6221@cindex macros, example of debugging with
6222Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
6223show our source files:
6224
6225@smallexample
6226$ cat sample.c
6227#include <stdio.h>
6228#include "sample.h"
6229
6230#define M 42
6231#define ADD(x) (M + x)
6232
6233main ()
6234@{
6235#define N 28
6236 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6237#undef N
6238 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6239#define N 1729
6240 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
6241@}
6242$ cat sample.h
6243#define Q <
6244$
6245@end smallexample
6246
6247Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
6248We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
6249compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
6250information.
6251
6252@smallexample
6253$ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
6254$
6255@end smallexample
6256
6257Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
6258
6259@smallexample
6260$ gdb -nw sample
6261GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
6262Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6263GDB is free software, @dots{}
6264(gdb)
6265@end smallexample
6266
6267We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
6268program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
6269to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
6270
6271@smallexample
6272(gdb) list main
62733
62744 #define M 42
62755 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
62766
62777 main ()
62788 @{
62799 #define N 28
628010 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
628111 #undef N
628212 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
475b0867 6283(gdb) info macro ADD
e2e0bcd1
JB
6284Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
6285#define ADD(x) (M + x)
475b0867 6286(gdb) info macro Q
e2e0bcd1
JB
6287Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
6288 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
6289#define Q <
6290(gdb) macro expand ADD(1)
6291expands to: (42 + 1)
6292(gdb) macro expand-once ADD(1)
6293expands to: once (M + 1)
6294(gdb)
6295@end smallexample
6296
6297In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
6298the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
6299@code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
6300which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
6301
6302Once the program is running, GDB uses the macro definitions in force at
6303the source line of the current stack frame:
6304
6305@smallexample
6306(gdb) break main
6307Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
6308(gdb) run
6309Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
6310
6311Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
631210 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6313(gdb)
6314@end smallexample
6315
6316At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
6317
6318@smallexample
475b0867 6319(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6320Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
6321#define N 28
6322(gdb) macro expand N Q M
6323expands to: 28 < 42
6324(gdb) print N Q M
6325$1 = 1
6326(gdb)
6327@end smallexample
6328
6329As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
6330give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
6331thereof) in force at each point:
6332
6333@smallexample
6334(gdb) next
6335Hello, world!
633612 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
475b0867 6337(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6338The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
6339at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
6340(gdb) next
6341We're so creative.
634214 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
475b0867 6343(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6344Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
6345#define N 1729
6346(gdb) macro expand N Q M
6347expands to: 1729 < 42
6348(gdb) print N Q M
6349$2 = 0
6350(gdb)
6351@end smallexample
6352
6353
b37052ae
EZ
6354@node Tracepoints
6355@chapter Tracepoints
6356@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
6357@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
6358
6359@cindex tracepoints
6360In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
6361the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
6362anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
6363depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
6364might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
6365fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
6366to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
6367
6368Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
6369specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
6370arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
6371Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
6372those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
6373expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
6374for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
6375a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
6376in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
6377values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
6378unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
6379
6380The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
2c0069bb
EZ
6381targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know how
6382to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the remote
6383stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN} support
6384tracepoints as of this writing.
b37052ae
EZ
6385
6386This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
6387
6388@menu
6389* Set Tracepoints::
6390* Analyze Collected Data::
6391* Tracepoint Variables::
6392@end menu
6393
6394@node Set Tracepoints
6395@section Commands to Set Tracepoints
6396
6397Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
6398tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
6399tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
6400breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
6401one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
6402tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
6403work on.
6404
6405For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
6406of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
6407it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
6408local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
6409commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
6410tracepoint was hit.
6411
6412This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
6413conditions and actions.
6414
6415@menu
6416* Create and Delete Tracepoints::
6417* Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
6418* Tracepoint Passcounts::
6419* Tracepoint Actions::
6420* Listing Tracepoints::
6421* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
6422@end menu
6423
6424@node Create and Delete Tracepoints
6425@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
6426
6427@table @code
6428@cindex set tracepoint
6429@kindex trace
6430@item trace
6431The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
6432Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
6433the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
6434defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
6435debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
6436program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
6437doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
6438cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
6439running.
6440
6441Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
6442
6443@smallexample
6444(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
6445
6446(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
6447
6448(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
6449
6450(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
6451
6452(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
6453@end smallexample
6454
6455@noindent
6456You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
6457
6458@vindex $tpnum
6459@cindex last tracepoint number
6460@cindex recent tracepoint number
6461@cindex tracepoint number
6462The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
6463of the most recently set tracepoint.
6464
6465@kindex delete tracepoint
6466@cindex tracepoint deletion
6467@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6468Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
6469default is to delete all tracepoints.
6470
6471Examples:
6472
6473@smallexample
6474(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
6475
6476(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
6477@end smallexample
6478
6479@noindent
6480You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
6481@end table
6482
6483@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6484@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6485
6486@table @code
6487@kindex disable tracepoint
6488@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6489Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
6490@var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
6491the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
6492a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
6493
6494@kindex enable tracepoint
6495@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6496Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
6497tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
6498run.
6499@end table
6500
6501@node Tracepoint Passcounts
6502@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
6503
6504@table @code
6505@kindex passcount
6506@cindex tracepoint pass count
6507@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
6508Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
6509automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
6510@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
6511the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
6512@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
6513passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
6514given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
6515user.
6516
6517Examples:
6518
6519@smallexample
6826cf00
EZ
6520(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
6521@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
b37052ae
EZ
6522
6523(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
6826cf00 6524@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
b37052ae
EZ
6525(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6526(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
6527(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
6528(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
6529(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
6530(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
6826cf00
EZ
6531@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
6532@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
6533@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
b37052ae
EZ
6534@end smallexample
6535@end table
6536
6537@node Tracepoint Actions
6538@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
6539
6540@table @code
6541@kindex actions
6542@cindex tracepoint actions
6543@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6544This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
6545tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
6546specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
6547recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
6548@code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
6549actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
6550terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
6551far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
6552@code{while-stepping}.
6553
6554@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
6555To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
6556and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
6557
6558@smallexample
6559(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
6560
6826cf00 6561(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
b37052ae 6562
6826cf00 6563(@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
b37052ae
EZ
6564@end smallexample
6565
6566In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
6567commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
6568hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
6569following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
6570followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
6571@code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
6572@code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
6573@code{end} command.
6574
6575@smallexample
6576(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6577(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6578Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
6579> collect bar,baz
6580> collect $regs
6581> while-stepping 12
6582 > collect $fp, $sp
6583 > end
6584end
6585@end smallexample
6586
6587@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
6588@item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
6589Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
6590This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
6591In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
6592special arguments are supported:
6593
6594@table @code
6595@item $regs
6596collect all registers
6597
6598@item $args
6599collect all function arguments
6600
6601@item $locals
6602collect all local variables.
6603@end table
6604
6605You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
6606with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
6607arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
6608
f5c37c66
EZ
6609The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
6610particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
6611
b37052ae
EZ
6612@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
6613@item while-stepping @var{n}
6614Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
6615new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
6616followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
6617its own @code{end} command):
6618
6619@smallexample
6620> while-stepping 12
6621 > collect $regs, myglobal
6622 > end
6623>
6624@end smallexample
6625
6626@noindent
6627You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
6628@code{stepping}.
6629@end table
6630
6631@node Listing Tracepoints
6632@subsection Listing Tracepoints
6633
6634@table @code
6635@kindex info tracepoints
6636@cindex information about tracepoints
6637@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8a037dd7 6638Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
798c8bc6 6639a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
b37052ae
EZ
6640defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
6641shown:
6642
6643@itemize @bullet
6644@item
6645its number
6646@item
6647whether it is enabled or disabled
6648@item
6649its address
6650@item
6651its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
6652@item
6653its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
6654@item
6655where in the source files is the tracepoint set
6656@item
6657its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
6658@end itemize
6659
6660@smallexample
6661(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
6662Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
66631 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
6826cf00
EZ
66642 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
66653 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
b37052ae
EZ
6666(@value{GDBP})
6667@end smallexample
6668
6669@noindent
6670This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
6671@end table
6672
6673@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6674@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6675
6676@table @code
6677@kindex tstart
6678@cindex start a new trace experiment
6679@cindex collected data discarded
6680@item tstart
6681This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
6682begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
6683the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
6684experiment.
6685
6686@kindex tstop
6687@cindex stop a running trace experiment
6688@item tstop
6689This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
6690stops collecting data.
6691
6692@strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
6693automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
6694(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
6695
6696@kindex tstatus
6697@cindex status of trace data collection
6698@cindex trace experiment, status of
6699@item tstatus
6700This command displays the status of the current trace data
6701collection.
6702@end table
6703
6704Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
6705
6706@smallexample
6707(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
6708(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6709Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
6710> collect $regs,$locals,$args
6711> while-stepping 11
6712 > collect $regs
6713 > end
6714> end
6715(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6716 [time passes @dots{}]
6717(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6718@end smallexample
6719
6720
6721@node Analyze Collected Data
6722@section Using the collected data
6723
6724After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6725for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6726collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6727snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
6728consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6729examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6730specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6731snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6732registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6733rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6734debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6735(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6736behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6737when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
6738the buffer will fail.
6739
6740@menu
6741* tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
6742* tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
6743* save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
6744@end menu
6745
6746@node tfind
6747@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6748
6749@kindex tfind
6750@cindex select trace snapshot
6751@cindex find trace snapshot
6752The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6753@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6754counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6755snapshot is selected.
6756
6757Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6758
6759@table @code
6760@item tfind start
6761Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
6762@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6763
6764@item tfind none
6765Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6766
6767@item tfind end
6768Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6769
6770@item tfind
6771No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6772
6773@item tfind -
6774Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
6775retracing earlier steps.
6776
6777@item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6778Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
6779proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
6780argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6781for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6782
6783@item tfind pc @var{addr}
6784Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6785program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6786snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6787snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6788
6789@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6790Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6791addresses.
6792
6793@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6794Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6795@var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6796
6797@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6798Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
6799the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6800that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6801trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6802next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6803@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6804stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6805@end table
6806
6807The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6808designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
6809instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6810snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6811trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6812simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6813snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6814@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6815The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6816for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
6817no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
6818(PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
6819no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
6820tracepoint as the current one.
6821
6822In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
6823these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
6824scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
6825you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
6826registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
6827
6828@smallexample
6829(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6830(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6831> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
6832 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
6833> tfind
6834> end
6835
6836Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
6837Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
6838Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
6839Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
6840Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
6841Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
6842Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
6843Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
6844Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
6845Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
6846Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
6847@end smallexample
6848
6849Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
6850the buffer:
6851
6852@smallexample
6853(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6854(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6855> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
6856> tfind line
6857> end
6858
6859Frame 0, X = 1
6860Frame 7, X = 2
6861Frame 13, X = 255
6862@end smallexample
6863
6864@node tdump
6865@subsection @code{tdump}
6866@kindex tdump
6867@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
6868@cindex tracepoint data, display
6869
6870This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
6871the current trace snapshot.
6872
6873@smallexample
6874(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
6875(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6876Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
6877> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
6878> end
6879
6880(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6881
6882(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
6883#0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
6884at gdb_test.c:444
6885444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
6886
6887(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
6888Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
6889d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
6890d1 0x18 24
6891d2 0x80 128
6892d3 0x33 51
6893d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
6894d5 0x22 34
6895d6 0xe0 224
6896d7 0x380035 3670069
6897a0 0x19e24a 1696330
6898a1 0x3000668 50333288
6899a2 0x100 256
6900a3 0x322000 3284992
6901a4 0x3000698 50333336
6902a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
6903fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
6904sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
6905ps 0x0 0
6906pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
6907fpcontrol 0x0 0
6908fpstatus 0x0 0
6909fpiaddr 0x0 0
6910p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
6911p1 = (void *) 0x11
6912p2 = (void *) 0x22
6913p3 = (void *) 0x33
6914p4 = (void *) 0x44
6915p5 = (void *) 0x55
6916p6 = (void *) 0x66
6917gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
6918
6919(@value{GDBP})
6920@end smallexample
6921
6922@node save-tracepoints
6923@subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
6924@kindex save-tracepoints
6925@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
6926
6927This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
6928their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
6929suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
6930tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
6931Files}).
6932
6933@node Tracepoint Variables
6934@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
6935@cindex tracepoint variables
6936@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
6937
6938@table @code
6939@vindex $trace_frame
6940@item (int) $trace_frame
6941The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
6942snapshot is selected.
6943
6944@vindex $tracepoint
6945@item (int) $tracepoint
6946The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
6947
6948@vindex $trace_line
6949@item (int) $trace_line
6950The line number for the current trace snapshot.
6951
6952@vindex $trace_file
6953@item (char []) $trace_file
6954The source file for the current trace snapshot.
6955
6956@vindex $trace_func
6957@item (char []) $trace_func
6958The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
6959@end table
6960
6961Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
6962use @code{output} instead.
6963
6964Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
6965stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
6966data.
6967
6968@smallexample
6969(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6970
6971(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
6972> output $trace_file
6973> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
6974> tfind
6975> end
6976@end smallexample
6977
df0cd8c5
JB
6978@node Overlays
6979@chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
6980@cindex overlays
6981
6982If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
6983memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
6984problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
6985use overlays.
6986
6987@menu
6988* How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
6989* Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
6990* Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
6991 mapped by asking the inferior.
6992* Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
6993@end menu
6994
6995@node How Overlays Work
6996@section How Overlays Work
6997@cindex mapped overlays
6998@cindex unmapped overlays
6999@cindex load address, overlay's
7000@cindex mapped address
7001@cindex overlay area
7002
7003Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
7004kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
7005other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
7006management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
7007adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
7008
7009One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
7010independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
7011@dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
7012their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
7013instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
7014largest overlay as well.
7015
7016Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
7017overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
7018for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
7019there.
7020
c928edc0
AC
7021@c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
7022@c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
7023@c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
7024
474c8240 7025@smallexample
df0cd8c5 7026@group
c928edc0
AC
7027 Data Instruction Larger
7028Address Space Address Space Address Space
7029+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
7030| | | | | |
7031+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
7032| program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
7033| variables | | program | | +-----------+
7034| and heap | | | | | |
7035+-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
7036| | +-----------+ | | | load address
7037+-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
7038 | | | | | |
7039 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
7040 address | | | | | |
7041 | overlay | <-' | | |
7042 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
7043 | | <---. | | load address
7044 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
7045 | | | |
7046 +-----------+ | |
7047 +-----------+
7048 | |
7049 +-----------+
7050
7051 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
df0cd8c5 7052@end group
474c8240 7053@end smallexample
df0cd8c5 7054
c928edc0
AC
7055The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
7056and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
7057its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
7058Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
7059may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
7060data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
7061program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
7062program and the overlay area.
df0cd8c5
JB
7063
7064An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
7065@dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
7066instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
7067in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
7068is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
7069the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
7070called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
7071
7072Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
7073program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
7074global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
7075
7076@itemize @bullet
7077
7078@item
7079Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
7080must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
7081return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
7082overlay, and your program will probably crash.
7083
7084@item
7085If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
7086will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
7087your program's performance.
7088
7089@item
7090The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
7091overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
7092mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
7093and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
7094You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
7095addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
7096ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
7097
7098@item
7099The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
7100to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
7101instruction and data spaces.
7102
7103@end itemize
7104
7105The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
7106improved in many ways:
7107
7108@itemize @bullet
7109
7110@item
7111If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
7112hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
7113contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
7114This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
7115area in the usual way.
7116
7117@item
7118If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
7119overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
7120
7121@item
7122You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
7123general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
7124code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
7125return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
7126the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
7127must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
7128different data overlay into the same mapped area.
7129
7130@end itemize
7131
7132
7133@node Overlay Commands
7134@section Overlay Commands
7135
7136To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
7137correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
7138virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
7139mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
7140@value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
7141variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
7142
7143@value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
7144you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
7145
7146@table @code
7147@item overlay off
7148@kindex overlay off
7149Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
7150disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
7151always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
7152overlay support is disabled.
7153
7154@item overlay manual
7155@kindex overlay manual
7156@cindex manual overlay debugging
7157Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7158relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
7159using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
7160commands described below.
7161
7162@item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
7163@itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
7164@kindex overlay map-overlay
7165@cindex map an overlay
7166Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
7167be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
7168overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
7169functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
7170that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
7171@var{overlay} are now unmapped.
7172
7173@item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
7174@itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
7175@kindex overlay unmap-overlay
7176@cindex unmap an overlay
7177Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
7178must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
7179When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
7180overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
7181
7182@item overlay auto
7183@kindex overlay auto
7184Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7185consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
7186to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
7187Overlay Debugging}.
7188
7189@item overlay load-target
7190@itemx overlay load
7191@kindex overlay load-target
7192@cindex reloading the overlay table
7193Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
7194re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
7195stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
7196overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
7197useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
7198
7199@item overlay list-overlays
7200@itemx overlay list
7201@cindex listing mapped overlays
7202Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
7203addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
7204
7205@end table
7206
7207Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
7208of the function the address falls in:
7209
474c8240 7210@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7211(gdb) print main
7212$3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
474c8240 7213@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7214@noindent
7215When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
7216unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
7217asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
7218unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
7219
474c8240 7220@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7221(gdb) overlay list
7222No sections are mapped.
7223(gdb) print foo
7224$5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
474c8240 7225@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7226@noindent
7227When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
7228name normally:
7229
474c8240 7230@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7231(gdb) overlay list
7232Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
7233 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
7234(gdb) print foo
7235$6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
474c8240 7236@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7237
7238When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
7239address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
7240overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
7241@code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
7242code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
7243
7244@itemize @bullet
7245@item
7246@cindex breakpoints in overlays
7247@cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
7248You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
7249@value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
7250@item
7251@value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
7252unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
7253overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
7254you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
7255breakpoints properly.
7256@end itemize
7257
7258
7259@node Automatic Overlay Debugging
7260@section Automatic Overlay Debugging
7261@cindex automatic overlay debugging
7262
7263@value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
7264are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
7265inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
7266@code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
7267looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
7268current state of the overlays.
7269
7270Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
7271@value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
7272
7273@table @asis
7274
7275@item @code{_ovly_table}:
7276This variable must be an array of the following structures:
7277
474c8240 7278@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7279struct
7280@{
7281 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
7282 unsigned long vma;
7283
7284 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
7285 unsigned long size;
7286
7287 /* The overlay's load address. */
7288 unsigned long lma;
7289
7290 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
7291 zero otherwise. */
7292 unsigned long mapped;
7293@}
474c8240 7294@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7295
7296@item @code{_novlys}:
7297This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
7298number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
7299
7300@end table
7301
7302To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
7303looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
7304@code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
7305executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
7306the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
7307currently mapped.
7308
81d46470 7309In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
def71bfa 7310@code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
81d46470
MS
7311will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
7312calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
7313will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
7314are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
7315in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
7316overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
7317are not being executed.
df0cd8c5
JB
7318
7319@node Overlay Sample Program
7320@section Overlay Sample Program
7321@cindex overlay example program
7322
7323When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
7324at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
7325addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
7326Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
7327since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
7328architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
7329portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
7330
7331However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
7332program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
7333suite. The program consists of the following files from
7334@file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
7335
7336@table @file
7337@item overlays.c
7338The main program file.
7339@item ovlymgr.c
7340A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
7341@item foo.c
7342@itemx bar.c
7343@itemx baz.c
7344@itemx grbx.c
7345Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
7346@item d10v.ld
7347@itemx m32r.ld
7348Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
7349and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
7350@end table
7351
7352You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
7353cross-compiler like this:
7354
474c8240 7355@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7356$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
7357$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
7358$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
7359$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
7360$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
7361$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
7362$ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
7363 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
474c8240 7364@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7365
7366The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
7367you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
7368target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
7369
7370
6d2ebf8b 7371@node Languages
c906108c
SS
7372@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
7373@cindex languages
7374
c906108c
SS
7375Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
7376rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
7377dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
7378Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5d161b24 7379represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
c906108c 7380@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
c906108c
SS
7381
7382@cindex working language
7383Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
7384allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
7385native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
7386consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
7387language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
7388language}.
7389
7390@menu
7391* Setting:: Switching between source languages
7392* Show:: Displaying the language
c906108c 7393* Checks:: Type and range checks
c906108c
SS
7394* Support:: Supported languages
7395@end menu
7396
6d2ebf8b 7397@node Setting
c906108c
SS
7398@section Switching between source languages
7399
7400There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
7401set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
7402@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
7403defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
7404used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
7405are printed, etc.
7406
7407In addition to the working language, every source file that
7408@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
7409file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
7410source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
7411language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
b37052ae 7412controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
c906108c 7413show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
d4f3574e
SS
7414set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
7415set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
7416Displaying the language}.
c906108c
SS
7417
7418This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5d161b24 7419as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
c906108c
SS
7420another language. In that case, make the
7421program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
7422@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
7423program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
7424
7425@menu
7426* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
7427* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
7428* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7429@end menu
7430
6d2ebf8b 7431@node Filenames
c906108c
SS
7432@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
7433
7434If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
7435@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
7436
7437@table @file
7438
7439@item .c
7440C source file
7441
7442@item .C
7443@itemx .cc
7444@itemx .cp
7445@itemx .cpp
7446@itemx .cxx
7447@itemx .c++
b37052ae 7448C@t{++} source file
c906108c
SS
7449
7450@item .f
7451@itemx .F
7452Fortran source file
7453
c906108c
SS
7454@item .mod
7455Modula-2 source file
c906108c
SS
7456
7457@item .s
7458@itemx .S
7459Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
7460@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
7461@end table
7462
7463In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
7464extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
7465
6d2ebf8b 7466@node Manually
c906108c
SS
7467@subsection Setting the working language
7468
7469If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
7470expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
7471your program.
7472
7473@kindex set language
7474If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
7475command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5d161b24 7476a language, such as
c906108c 7477@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
c906108c
SS
7478For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
7479
c906108c
SS
7480Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
7481language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
7482to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
7483source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
7484languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
7485source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
7486command such as:
7487
474c8240 7488@smallexample
c906108c 7489print a = b + c
474c8240 7490@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
7491
7492@noindent
7493might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
7494@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
7495printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
7496@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
c906108c 7497
6d2ebf8b 7498@node Automatically
c906108c
SS
7499@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7500
7501To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
7502@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
7503then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
7504frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
7505working language to the language recorded for the function in that
7506frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
7507or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
7508does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
7509not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
7510
7511This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
7512entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
7513written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
7514a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
7515case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
7516
6d2ebf8b 7517@node Show
c906108c 7518@section Displaying the language
c906108c
SS
7519
7520The following commands help you find out which language is the
7521working language, and also what language source files were written in.
7522
7523@kindex show language
d4f3574e
SS
7524@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
7525@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
c906108c
SS
7526@table @code
7527@item show language
7528Display the current working language. This is the
7529language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
7530build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
7531
7532@item info frame
5d161b24 7533Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
c906108c 7534working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5d161b24 7535@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
7536information listed here.
7537
7538@item info source
7539Display the source language of this source file.
5d161b24 7540@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
7541information listed here.
7542@end table
7543
7544In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
7545not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
7546with a language explicitly:
7547
7548@kindex set extension-language
7549@kindex info extensions
7550@table @code
7551@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
7552Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
7553the source language @var{language}.
7554
7555@item info extensions
7556List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
7557@end table
7558
6d2ebf8b 7559@node Checks
c906108c
SS
7560@section Type and range checking
7561
7562@quotation
7563@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
7564checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
7565section documents the intended facilities.
7566@end quotation
7567@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
7568
7569Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
7570errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
7571checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
7572sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
7573these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
7574by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
7575errors when your program is running.
7576
7577@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
7578Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
7579can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
7580the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
7581@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
7582your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
7583for the default settings of supported languages.
7584
7585@menu
7586* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
7587* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
7588@end menu
7589
7590@cindex type checking
7591@cindex checks, type
6d2ebf8b 7592@node Type Checking
c906108c
SS
7593@subsection An overview of type checking
7594
7595Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
7596arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
7597otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
7598errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
7599
7600@smallexample
76011 + 2 @result{} 3
7602@exdent but
7603@error{} 1 + 2.3
7604@end smallexample
7605
7606The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
7607type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
7608
5d161b24
DB
7609For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
7610@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
7611to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
7612or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
c906108c
SS
7613but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
7614these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
7615also issues a warning.
7616
5d161b24
DB
7617Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
7618related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
7619For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
7620a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
7621with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
c906108c
SS
7622the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
7623
7624Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
7625instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
7626operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
7627represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
7628operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
7629details on specific languages.
7630
7631@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
7632
d4f3574e 7633@kindex set check@r{, type}
c906108c
SS
7634@kindex set check type
7635@kindex show check type
7636@table @code
7637@item set check type auto
7638Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
7639@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7640each language.
7641
7642@item set check type on
7643@itemx set check type off
7644Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7645current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
7646match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
d4f3574e 7647evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
c906108c
SS
7648message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
7649
7650@item set check type warn
7651Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
7652evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
7653be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
7654numbers and structures.
7655
7656@item show type
5d161b24 7657Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
7658is setting it automatically.
7659@end table
7660
7661@cindex range checking
7662@cindex checks, range
6d2ebf8b 7663@node Range Checking
c906108c
SS
7664@subsection An overview of range checking
7665
7666In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
7667bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
7668checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
7669computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
7670not exceed the bounds of the array.
7671
7672For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
7673@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
7674always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
7675warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
7676
7677A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
7678array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
7679of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
7680error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
7681result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
7682the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
7683
474c8240 7684@smallexample
c906108c 7685@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
474c8240 7686@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
7687
7688This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
7689specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
7690Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
7691
7692@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
7693
d4f3574e 7694@kindex set check@r{, range}
c906108c
SS
7695@kindex set check range
7696@kindex show check range
7697@table @code
7698@item set check range auto
7699Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
7700@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7701each language.
7702
7703@item set check range on
7704@itemx set check range off
7705Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7706current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
c3f6f71d
JM
7707match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
7708then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
c906108c
SS
7709
7710@item set check range warn
7711Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
7712but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
7713expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
7714memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
7715systems).
7716
7717@item show range
7718Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
7719being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
7720@end table
c906108c 7721
6d2ebf8b 7722@node Support
c906108c 7723@section Supported languages
c906108c 7724
e632838e 7725@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Fortran, Java, assembly, and Modula-2.
cce74817 7726@c This is false ...
c906108c
SS
7727Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
7728language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
7729and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
7730,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
7731language.
7732
7733The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
7734supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
7735tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
7736@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
7737formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
7738books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
7739language reference or tutorial.
7740
c906108c 7741@menu
b37052ae 7742* C:: C and C@t{++}
cce74817 7743* Modula-2:: Modula-2
c906108c
SS
7744@end menu
7745
6d2ebf8b 7746@node C
b37052ae 7747@subsection C and C@t{++}
7a292a7a 7748
b37052ae
EZ
7749@cindex C and C@t{++}
7750@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
c906108c 7751
b37052ae 7752Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
c906108c
SS
7753to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
7754together.
7755
41afff9a
EZ
7756@cindex C@t{++}
7757@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
b37052ae
EZ
7758@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
7759The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
7760compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
7761effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
7762C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7763compiler (@code{aCC}).
7764
b37052ae 7765For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the stabs debugging
c906108c
SS
7766format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
7767command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
7768@ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
7769CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
c906108c 7770
c906108c 7771@menu
b37052ae
EZ
7772* C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
7773* C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
7774* C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
7775* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
7776* C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
c906108c 7777* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
b37052ae 7778* Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 7779@end menu
c906108c 7780
6d2ebf8b 7781@node C Operators
b37052ae 7782@subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
7a292a7a 7783
b37052ae 7784@cindex C and C@t{++} operators
c906108c
SS
7785
7786Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7787@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5d161b24 7788often defined on groups of types.
c906108c 7789
b37052ae 7790For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
c906108c
SS
7791
7792@itemize @bullet
53a5351d 7793
c906108c 7794@item
c906108c 7795@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
b37052ae 7796specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
c906108c
SS
7797
7798@item
d4f3574e
SS
7799@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
7800@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
c906108c
SS
7801
7802@item
53a5351d 7803@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
c906108c
SS
7804
7805@item
7806@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
53a5351d 7807
c906108c
SS
7808@end itemize
7809
7810@noindent
7811The following operators are supported. They are listed here
7812in order of increasing precedence:
7813
7814@table @code
7815@item ,
7816The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
7817are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
7818expression being the last expression evaluated.
7819
7820@item =
7821Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
7822assigned. Defined on scalar types.
7823
7824@item @var{op}=
7825Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
7826and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
d4f3574e 7827@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
c906108c
SS
7828@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
7829@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
7830
7831@item ?:
7832The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
7833of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
7834integral type.
7835
7836@item ||
7837Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7838
7839@item &&
7840Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7841
7842@item |
7843Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7844
7845@item ^
7846Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7847
7848@item &
7849Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7850
7851@item ==@r{, }!=
7852Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
7853expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
7854
7855@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
7856Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
7857Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
7858and non-zero for true.
7859
7860@item <<@r{, }>>
7861left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
7862
7863@item @@
7864The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7865
7866@item +@r{, }-
7867Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
7868pointer types.
7869
7870@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
7871Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
7872defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
7873integral types.
7874
7875@item ++@r{, }--
7876Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
7877operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
7878when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
7879operation takes place.
7880
7881@item *
7882Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
7883@code{++}.
7884
7885@item &
7886Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
7887
b37052ae
EZ
7888For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
7889allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
c906108c 7890(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
b37052ae 7891where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
c906108c 7892stored.
c906108c
SS
7893
7894@item -
7895Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
7896precedence as @code{++}.
7897
7898@item !
7899Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7900@code{++}.
7901
7902@item ~
7903Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7904@code{++}.
7905
7906
7907@item .@r{, }->
7908Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
7909@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
7910pointer based on the stored type information.
7911Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
7912
c906108c
SS
7913@item .*@r{, }->*
7914Dereferences of pointers to members.
c906108c
SS
7915
7916@item []
7917Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
7918@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7919
7920@item ()
7921Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7922
c906108c 7923@item ::
b37052ae 7924C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
7a292a7a 7925and @code{class} types.
c906108c
SS
7926
7927@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
7928Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
7929(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
7930above.
c906108c
SS
7931@end table
7932
c906108c
SS
7933If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
7934attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
7935predefined meaning.
c906108c 7936
c906108c 7937@menu
5d161b24 7938* C Constants::
c906108c
SS
7939@end menu
7940
6d2ebf8b 7941@node C Constants
b37052ae 7942@subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 7943
b37052ae 7944@cindex C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 7945
b37052ae 7946@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
c906108c 7947following ways:
c906108c
SS
7948
7949@itemize @bullet
7950@item
7951Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
6ca652b0
EZ
7952specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
7953by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
c906108c
SS
7954@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
7955@code{long} value.
7956
7957@item
7958Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
7959point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
7960exponent. An exponent is of the form:
7961@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
7962sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
d4f3574e
SS
7963A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
7964@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
7965the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
7966a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
7967constant.
c906108c
SS
7968
7969@item
7970Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
7971integral equivalents.
7972
7973@item
7974Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
7975(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
d4f3574e 7976(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
c906108c
SS
7977be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
7978the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
7979of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
7980@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
7981@samp{\n} for newline.
7982
7983@item
96a2c332
SS
7984String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
7985double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
7986above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
7987a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
7988characters.
c906108c
SS
7989
7990@item
7991Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
7992to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
7993
7994@item
7995Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
7996and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
7997integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
7998and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
7999@end itemize
8000
c906108c 8001@menu
5d161b24
DB
8002* C plus plus expressions::
8003* C Defaults::
8004* C Checks::
c906108c 8005
5d161b24 8006* Debugging C::
c906108c
SS
8007@end menu
8008
6d2ebf8b 8009@node C plus plus expressions
b37052ae
EZ
8010@subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
8011
8012@cindex expressions in C@t{++}
8013@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
8014
8015@cindex C@t{++} support, not in @sc{coff}
8016@cindex @sc{coff} versus C@t{++}
8017@cindex C@t{++} and object formats
8018@cindex object formats and C@t{++}
8019@cindex a.out and C@t{++}
8020@cindex @sc{ecoff} and C@t{++}
8021@cindex @sc{xcoff} and C@t{++}
8022@cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C@t{++}
8023@cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8024@c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
8025@c periodically whether this has happened...
8026@quotation
b37052ae
EZ
8027@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
8028proper compiler. Typically, C@t{++} debugging depends on the use of
c906108c
SS
8029additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
8030special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
8031@sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
8032symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
8033you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
8034extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
b37052ae 8035@sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8036support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
8037@end quotation
c906108c
SS
8038
8039@enumerate
8040
8041@cindex member functions
8042@item
8043Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
8044
474c8240 8045@smallexample
c906108c 8046count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
474c8240 8047@end smallexample
c906108c 8048
41afff9a 8049@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
b37052ae 8050@cindex namespace in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8051@item
8052While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
8053expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
8054that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
b37052ae 8055pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
c906108c 8056
c906108c 8057@cindex call overloaded functions
d4f3574e 8058@cindex overloaded functions, calling
b37052ae 8059@cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8060@item
8061You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
d4f3574e 8062call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
c906108c
SS
8063perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
8064calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
8065in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
8066default arguments.
8067
8068It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
8069promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
8070class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
8071functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
8072number of function arguments.
8073
8074Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
8075@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
b37052ae 8076,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c 8077
d4f3574e 8078You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
c906108c
SS
8079explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
8080@smallexample
8081p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
8082@end smallexample
d4f3574e 8083
c906108c 8084The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
d4f3574e 8085see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
c906108c 8086
c906108c
SS
8087@cindex reference declarations
8088@item
b37052ae
EZ
8089@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
8090them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
c906108c
SS
8091dereferenced.
8092
8093In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
8094reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
8095avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
8096The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
8097you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
8098
8099@item
b37052ae 8100@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
c906108c
SS
8101expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
8102one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
8103necessary, for example in an expression like
8104@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
b37052ae 8105resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8106debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
8107@end enumerate
8108
b37052ae 8109In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
53a5351d
JM
8110calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
8111objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
8112invoking user-defined operators.
c906108c 8113
6d2ebf8b 8114@node C Defaults
b37052ae 8115@subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
7a292a7a 8116
b37052ae 8117@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
c906108c 8118
c906108c
SS
8119If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
8120both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
b37052ae 8121C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c 8122selects the working language.
c906108c
SS
8123
8124If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
8125recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
8126@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
b37052ae 8127these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
c906108c
SS
8128@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
8129for further details.
8130
c906108c
SS
8131@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
8132@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
8133@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7a292a7a 8134
6d2ebf8b 8135@node C Checks
b37052ae 8136@subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7a292a7a 8137
b37052ae 8138@cindex C and C@t{++} checks
c906108c 8139
b37052ae 8140By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
c906108c
SS
8141is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
8142considers two variables type equivalent if:
8143
8144@itemize @bullet
8145@item
8146The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
8147enumerated tag.
8148
8149@item
8150The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
8151declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
8152
8153@ignore
8154@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
8155@c FIXME--beers?
8156@item
8157The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
8158declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
8159compilers.)
8160@end ignore
8161@end itemize
8162
8163Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
8164indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
8165that is not itself an array.
c906108c 8166
6d2ebf8b 8167@node Debugging C
c906108c 8168@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
c906108c
SS
8169
8170The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
8171the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7a292a7a
SS
8172inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
8173appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
c906108c
SS
8174
8175The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
8176with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
8177,Expressions}.
8178
c906108c 8179@menu
5d161b24 8180* Debugging C plus plus::
c906108c
SS
8181@end menu
8182
6d2ebf8b 8183@node Debugging C plus plus
b37052ae 8184@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 8185
b37052ae 8186@cindex commands for C@t{++}
7a292a7a 8187
b37052ae
EZ
8188Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
8189designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
c906108c
SS
8190
8191@table @code
8192@cindex break in overloaded functions
8193@item @r{breakpoint menus}
8194When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
8195@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
8196you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
8197
b37052ae 8198@cindex overloading in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8199@item rbreak @var{regex}
8200Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
8201breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
8202classes.
8203@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
8204
b37052ae 8205@cindex C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
8206@item catch throw
8207@itemx catch catch
b37052ae 8208Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
c906108c
SS
8209Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
8210
8211@cindex inheritance
8212@item ptype @var{typename}
8213Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
8214@var{typename}.
8215@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
8216
b37052ae 8217@cindex C@t{++} symbol display
c906108c
SS
8218@item set print demangle
8219@itemx show print demangle
8220@itemx set print asm-demangle
8221@itemx show print asm-demangle
b37052ae
EZ
8222Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
8223displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
c906108c
SS
8224@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8225
8226@item set print object
8227@itemx show print object
8228Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
8229@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8230
8231@item set print vtbl
8232@itemx show print vtbl
8233Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
8234@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
c906108c 8235(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 8236ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
8237
8238@kindex set overload-resolution
d4f3574e 8239@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
c906108c 8240@item set overload-resolution on
b37052ae 8241Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
c906108c
SS
8242is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
8243and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
b37052ae 8244using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
d4f3574e 8245expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
c906108c
SS
8246message.
8247
8248@item set overload-resolution off
b37052ae 8249Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
c906108c
SS
8250overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8251chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
8252symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
8253overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8254searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
8255argument types.
c906108c
SS
8256
8257@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
8258You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
b37052ae 8259the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
c906108c
SS
8260@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
8261also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
8262available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
8263@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
8264@end table
c906108c 8265
6d2ebf8b 8266@node Modula-2
c906108c 8267@subsection Modula-2
7a292a7a 8268
d4f3574e 8269@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
c906108c
SS
8270
8271The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
8272output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
8273developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
8274attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
8275to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
8276table.
8277
8278@cindex expressions in Modula-2
8279@menu
8280* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
8281* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
8282* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
8283* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
8284* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
8285* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
8286* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8287* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8288@end menu
8289
6d2ebf8b 8290@node M2 Operators
c906108c
SS
8291@subsubsection Operators
8292@cindex Modula-2 operators
8293
8294Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
8295@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
8296often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
8297following definitions hold:
8298
8299@itemize @bullet
8300
8301@item
8302@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
8303their subranges.
8304
8305@item
8306@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
8307
8308@item
8309@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
8310
8311@item
8312@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
8313@var{type}}.
8314
8315@item
8316@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
8317
8318@item
8319@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
8320
8321@item
8322@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
8323@end itemize
8324
8325@noindent
8326The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
8327increasing precedence:
8328
8329@table @code
8330@item ,
8331Function argument or array index separator.
8332
8333@item :=
8334Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
8335@var{value}.
8336
8337@item <@r{, }>
8338Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
8339types.
8340
8341@item <=@r{, }>=
96a2c332 8342Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
c906108c
SS
8343on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
8344set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
8345
8346@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
8347Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
8348Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
8349available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
8350comment character.
8351
8352@item IN
8353Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
8354Same precedence as @code{<}.
8355
8356@item OR
8357Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
8358
8359@item AND@r{, }&
d4f3574e 8360Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
c906108c
SS
8361
8362@item @@
8363The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
8364
8365@item +@r{, }-
8366Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
8367and difference on set types.
8368
8369@item *
8370Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
8371on set types.
8372
8373@item /
8374Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
8375types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
8376
8377@item DIV@r{, }MOD
8378Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
8379precedence as @code{*}.
8380
8381@item -
8382Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
8383
8384@item ^
8385Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
8386
8387@item NOT
8388Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
8389@code{^}.
8390
8391@item .
8392@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
8393precedence as @code{^}.
8394
8395@item []
8396Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
8397
8398@item ()
8399Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
8400as @code{^}.
8401
8402@item ::@r{, }.
8403@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
8404@end table
8405
8406@quotation
8407@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
8408treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
8409@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
8410@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
8411@end quotation
8412
cb51c4e0 8413
6d2ebf8b 8414@node Built-In Func/Proc
c906108c 8415@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
cb51c4e0 8416@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
c906108c
SS
8417
8418Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
8419In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
8420
8421@table @var
8422
8423@item a
8424represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
8425
8426@item c
8427represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
8428
8429@item i
8430represents a variable or constant of integral type.
8431
8432@item m
8433represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
8434same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
8435be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
8436
8437@item n
8438represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
8439
8440@item r
8441represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
8442
8443@item t
8444represents a type.
8445
8446@item v
8447represents a variable.
8448
8449@item x
8450represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
8451explanation of the function for details.
8452@end table
8453
8454All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
8455
8456@table @code
8457@item ABS(@var{n})
8458Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
8459
8460@item CAP(@var{c})
8461If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
c3f6f71d 8462equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
c906108c
SS
8463
8464@item CHR(@var{i})
8465Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8466
8467@item DEC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 8468Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
8469
8470@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
8471Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8472new value.
8473
8474@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8475Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
8476set.
8477
8478@item FLOAT(@var{i})
8479Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
8480
8481@item HIGH(@var{a})
8482Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
8483
8484@item INC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 8485Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
8486
8487@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
8488Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8489new value.
8490
8491@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8492Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
8493there. Returns the new set.
8494
8495@item MAX(@var{t})
8496Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
8497
8498@item MIN(@var{t})
8499Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
8500
8501@item ODD(@var{i})
8502Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
8503
8504@item ORD(@var{x})
8505Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
c3f6f71d
JM
8506value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
8507@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
c906108c
SS
8508integral, character and enumerated types.
8509
8510@item SIZE(@var{x})
8511Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
8512
8513@item TRUNC(@var{r})
8514Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
8515
8516@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
8517Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8518@end table
8519
8520@quotation
8521@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
8522@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
8523an error.
8524@end quotation
8525
8526@cindex Modula-2 constants
6d2ebf8b 8527@node M2 Constants
c906108c
SS
8528@subsubsection Constants
8529
8530@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
8531ways:
8532
8533@itemize @bullet
8534
8535@item
8536Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
8537expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
8538rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
8539trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
8540
8541@item
8542Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
8543decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
8544then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
8545@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
8546digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
8547digits.
8548
8549@item
8550Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
8551like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
c3f6f71d 8552also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
c906108c
SS
8553followed by a @samp{C}.
8554
8555@item
8556String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
8557pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
8558Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
b37052ae 8559Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
c906108c
SS
8560sequences.
8561
8562@item
8563Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
8564
8565@item
8566Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
8567@code{FALSE}.
8568
8569@item
8570Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
8571
8572@item
8573Set constants are not yet supported.
8574@end itemize
8575
6d2ebf8b 8576@node M2 Defaults
c906108c
SS
8577@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
8578@cindex Modula-2 defaults
8579
8580If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8581both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 8582Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
8583selected the working language.
8584
8585If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8586code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
d4f3574e 8587working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
c906108c
SS
8588the language automatically}, for further details.
8589
6d2ebf8b 8590@node Deviations
c906108c
SS
8591@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
8592@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
8593
8594A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
8595This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
8596
8597@itemize @bullet
8598@item
8599Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
8600integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
8601debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
8602pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
8603through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
8604returned a pointer.)
8605
8606@item
8607C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
8608non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
8609escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
8610printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
8611
8612@item
8613The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
8614argument.
8615
8616@item
8617All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
8618@end itemize
8619
6d2ebf8b 8620@node M2 Checks
c906108c
SS
8621@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
8622@cindex Modula-2 checks
8623
8624@quotation
8625@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
8626range checking.
8627@end quotation
8628@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
8629
8630@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
8631
8632@itemize @bullet
8633@item
8634They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
8635@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
8636
8637@item
8638They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
8639@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
8640@end itemize
8641
8642As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
8643whose types are not equivalent is an error.
8644
8645Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8646index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
8647
6d2ebf8b 8648@node M2 Scope
c906108c
SS
8649@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8650@cindex scope
41afff9a 8651@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
c906108c
SS
8652@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
8653@ifinfo
41afff9a 8654@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
8655@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
8656@end ifinfo
8657@iftex
41afff9a 8658@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
8659@end iftex
8660
8661There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
8662(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
8663similar syntax:
8664
474c8240 8665@smallexample
c906108c
SS
8666
8667@var{module} . @var{id}
8668@var{scope} :: @var{id}
474c8240 8669@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8670
8671@noindent
8672where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
8673@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
8674identifier within your program, except another module.
8675
8676Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
8677specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
8678found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
8679enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
8680
8681Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
8682the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
8683definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
8684an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
8685module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
8686@var{module}.
8687
6d2ebf8b 8688@node GDB/M2
c906108c
SS
8689@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8690
8691Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
8692Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
b37052ae 8693specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
c906108c 8694@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
b37052ae 8695apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
c906108c
SS
8696analogue in Modula-2.
8697
8698The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
d4f3574e 8699with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
c906108c 8700intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
b37052ae 8701created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
c906108c 8702address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
d4f3574e 8703@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
c906108c
SS
8704
8705@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
8706In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
8707interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
c906108c 8708
6d2ebf8b 8709@node Symbols
c906108c
SS
8710@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
8711
d4f3574e 8712The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
c906108c
SS
8713symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
8714program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
8715does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
8716program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
8717(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
8718file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8719
8720@cindex symbol names
8721@cindex names of symbols
8722@cindex quoting names
8723Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
8724characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
8725most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
8726source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
8727are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
8728ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
8729@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
8730@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
8731
474c8240 8732@smallexample
c906108c 8733p 'foo.c'::x
474c8240 8734@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8735
8736@noindent
8737looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
8738
8739@table @code
8740@kindex info address
b37052ae 8741@cindex address of a symbol
c906108c
SS
8742@item info address @var{symbol}
8743Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
8744variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
8745local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
8746is always stored.
8747
8748Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
8749at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
8750the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
8751
3d67e040 8752@kindex info symbol
b37052ae 8753@cindex symbol from address
3d67e040
EZ
8754@item info symbol @var{addr}
8755Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
8756If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
8757nearest symbol and an offset from it:
8758
474c8240 8759@smallexample
3d67e040
EZ
8760(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
8761_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
474c8240 8762@end smallexample
3d67e040
EZ
8763
8764@noindent
8765This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
8766it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
8767
c906108c 8768@kindex whatis
d4f3574e
SS
8769@item whatis @var{expr}
8770Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
c906108c
SS
8771actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
8772assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
8773@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8774
8775@item whatis
8776Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8777
8778@kindex ptype
8779@item ptype @var{typename}
8780Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7a292a7a
SS
8781the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
8782@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
8783@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
c906108c 8784
d4f3574e 8785@item ptype @var{expr}
c906108c 8786@itemx ptype
d4f3574e 8787Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
c906108c
SS
8788differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
8789of just the name of the type.
8790
8791For example, for this variable declaration:
8792
474c8240 8793@smallexample
c906108c 8794struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
474c8240 8795@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8796
8797@noindent
8798the two commands give this output:
8799
474c8240 8800@smallexample
c906108c
SS
8801@group
8802(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
8803type = struct complex
8804(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
8805type = struct complex @{
8806 double real;
8807 double imag;
8808@}
8809@end group
474c8240 8810@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8811
8812@noindent
8813As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
8814the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8815
8816@kindex info types
8817@item info types @var{regexp}
8818@itemx info types
d4f3574e 8819Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
c906108c
SS
8820(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
8821complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
8822@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
d4f3574e 8823names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
c906108c
SS
8824information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
8825
8826This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
8827@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
8828lists all source files where a type is defined.
8829
b37052ae
EZ
8830@kindex info scope
8831@cindex local variables
8832@item info scope @var{addr}
8833List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
8834accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
8835preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
8836scope defined by that location. For example:
8837
8838@smallexample
8839(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
8840Scope for command_line_handler:
8841Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
8842Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
8843Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
8844Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
8845Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
8846Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
8847Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
8848@end smallexample
8849
f5c37c66
EZ
8850@noindent
8851This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
8852during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
8853collect}.
8854
c906108c
SS
8855@kindex info source
8856@item info source
919d772c
JB
8857Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
8858the function containing the current point of execution:
8859@itemize @bullet
8860@item
8861the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
8862@item
8863the directory it was compiled in,
8864@item
8865its length, in lines,
8866@item
8867which programming language it is written in,
8868@item
8869whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
8870if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
8871@item
8872whether the debugging information includes information about
8873preprocessor macros.
8874@end itemize
8875
c906108c
SS
8876
8877@kindex info sources
8878@item info sources
8879Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
8880debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
8881have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
8882
8883@kindex info functions
8884@item info functions
8885Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
8886
8887@item info functions @var{regexp}
8888Print the names and data types of all defined functions
8889whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
8890Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
8891include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
1c5dfdad
MS
8892start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
8893that conflict with the regular expression language (eg.
8894@samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
c906108c
SS
8895
8896@kindex info variables
8897@item info variables
8898Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
6ca652b0 8899outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
c906108c
SS
8900
8901@item info variables @var{regexp}
8902Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
8903variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
8904@var{regexp}.
8905
8906@ignore
8907This was never implemented.
8908@kindex info methods
8909@item info methods
8910@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
8911The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
b37052ae
EZ
8912methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
8913specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
8914C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
c906108c
SS
8915from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
8916@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
8917which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
8918@end ignore
8919
c906108c
SS
8920@cindex reloading symbols
8921Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7a292a7a
SS
8922be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
8923in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
8924running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
8925@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
c906108c
SS
8926
8927@table @code
8928@kindex set symbol-reloading
8929@item set symbol-reloading on
8930Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
8931object file with a particular name is seen again.
8932
8933@item set symbol-reloading off
6d2ebf8b
SS
8934Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
8935same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
8936running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
8937should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
8938may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
8939several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
8940name.
c906108c
SS
8941
8942@kindex show symbol-reloading
8943@item show symbol-reloading
8944Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
8945@end table
c906108c 8946
c906108c
SS
8947@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
8948@item set opaque-type-resolution on
8949Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
8950declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
8951@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
8952source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
8953another source file. The default is on.
8954
8955A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
8956the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
8957
8958@item set opaque-type-resolution off
8959Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
8960is printed as follows:
8961@smallexample
8962@{<no data fields>@}
8963@end smallexample
8964
8965@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
8966@item show opaque-type-resolution
8967Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
c906108c
SS
8968
8969@kindex maint print symbols
8970@cindex symbol dump
8971@kindex maint print psymbols
8972@cindex partial symbol dump
8973@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
8974@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
8975@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
8976Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
8977These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
8978symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
8979symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
8980collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
8981only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
8982command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
8983use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
8984symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
8985files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
8986@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
8987required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
8988@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
8989@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
8990@end table
8991
6d2ebf8b 8992@node Altering
c906108c
SS
8993@chapter Altering Execution
8994
8995Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
8996find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
8997correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
8998experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
8999program.
9000
9001For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7a292a7a
SS
9002locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
9003address, or even return prematurely from a function.
c906108c
SS
9004
9005@menu
9006* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
9007* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
c906108c 9008* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
c906108c
SS
9009* Returning:: Returning from a function
9010* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
9011* Patching:: Patching your program
9012@end menu
9013
6d2ebf8b 9014@node Assignment
c906108c
SS
9015@section Assignment to variables
9016
9017@cindex assignment
9018@cindex setting variables
9019To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
9020@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
9021
474c8240 9022@smallexample
c906108c 9023print x=4
474c8240 9024@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9025
9026@noindent
9027stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
5d161b24 9028value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
c906108c
SS
9029@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
9030information on operators in supported languages.
c906108c
SS
9031
9032@kindex set variable
9033@cindex variables, setting
9034If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
9035@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
9036really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
9037not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
9038,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
9039
c906108c
SS
9040If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
9041appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
9042variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
9043to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
9044program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
9045a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
9046command @code{set width}:
9047
474c8240 9048@smallexample
c906108c
SS
9049(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
9050type = double
9051(@value{GDBP}) p width
9052$4 = 13
9053(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
9054Invalid syntax in expression.
474c8240 9055@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9056
9057@noindent
9058The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
9059order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
9060
474c8240 9061@smallexample
c906108c 9062(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
474c8240 9063@end smallexample
53a5351d 9064
c906108c
SS
9065Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
9066with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
9067@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
9068your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
9069to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
9070the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
9071
474c8240 9072@smallexample
c906108c
SS
9073@group
9074(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
9075type = double
9076(@value{GDBP}) p g
9077$1 = 1
9078(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
2df3850c 9079(@value{GDBP}) p g
c906108c
SS
9080$2 = 1
9081(@value{GDBP}) r
9082The program being debugged has been started already.
9083Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
9084Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
6d2ebf8b
SS
9085"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
9086 Invalid bfd target.
c906108c
SS
9087(@value{GDBP}) show g
9088The current BFD target is "=4".
9089@end group
474c8240 9090@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9091
9092@noindent
9093The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
9094@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
9095@code{g}, use
9096
474c8240 9097@smallexample
c906108c 9098(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
474c8240 9099@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9100
9101@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
9102freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
9103and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
9104same length or shorter.
9105@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
9106@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
9107
9108To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
9109construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
9110(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
9111to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
9112and representation in memory), and
9113
474c8240 9114@smallexample
c906108c 9115set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
474c8240 9116@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9117
9118@noindent
9119stores the value 4 into that memory location.
9120
6d2ebf8b 9121@node Jumping
c906108c
SS
9122@section Continuing at a different address
9123
9124Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
9125it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
9126an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
9127
9128@table @code
9129@kindex jump
9130@item jump @var{linespec}
9131Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
9132immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
9133source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
9134@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
9135in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
9136breakpoints}.
9137
9138The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
9139the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
9140register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
9141a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
9142be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
9143of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
9144confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
9145executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
9146well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
9147
9148@item jump *@var{address}
9149Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
9150@end table
9151
c906108c 9152@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
53a5351d
JM
9153On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
9154command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
9155difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
9156changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
9157example,
c906108c 9158
474c8240 9159@smallexample
c906108c 9160set $pc = 0x485
474c8240 9161@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9162
9163@noindent
9164makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
9165address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
9166@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
c906108c
SS
9167
9168The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
9169up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
9170that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
9171detail.
9172
c906108c 9173@c @group
6d2ebf8b 9174@node Signaling
c906108c
SS
9175@section Giving your program a signal
9176
9177@table @code
9178@kindex signal
9179@item signal @var{signal}
9180Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
9181signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
9182signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
9183SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
9184
9185Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
9186giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
9187a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
9188@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
9189signal.
9190
9191@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
9192after executing the command.
9193@end table
9194@c @end group
9195
9196Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
9197@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
9198causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
9199the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
9200passes the signal directly to your program.
9201
c906108c 9202
6d2ebf8b 9203@node Returning
c906108c
SS
9204@section Returning from a function
9205
9206@table @code
9207@cindex returning from a function
9208@kindex return
9209@item return
9210@itemx return @var{expression}
9211You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
9212command. If you give an
9213@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
9214value.
9215@end table
9216
9217When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
9218(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
9219discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
9220be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
9221
9222This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
9223frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
9224innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
9225specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
9226of functions.
9227
9228The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
9229program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
9230returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
9231and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
9232selected stack frame returns naturally.
9233
6d2ebf8b 9234@node Calling
c906108c
SS
9235@section Calling program functions
9236
9237@cindex calling functions
9238@kindex call
9239@table @code
9240@item call @var{expr}
9241Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
9242returned values.
9243@end table
9244
9245You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
9246execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
5d161b24
DB
9247with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
9248is printed and saved in the value history.
c906108c 9249
6d2ebf8b 9250@node Patching
c906108c 9251@section Patching programs
7a292a7a 9252
c906108c
SS
9253@cindex patching binaries
9254@cindex writing into executables
c906108c 9255@cindex writing into corefiles
c906108c 9256
7a292a7a
SS
9257By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
9258executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
9259alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
9260patching your program's binary.
c906108c
SS
9261
9262If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
9263explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
9264want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
9265repairs.
9266
9267@table @code
9268@kindex set write
9269@item set write on
9270@itemx set write off
7a292a7a
SS
9271If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
9272core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
c906108c
SS
9273off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
9274
9275If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7a292a7a
SS
9276@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
9277write}, for your new setting to take effect.
c906108c
SS
9278
9279@item show write
9280@kindex show write
7a292a7a
SS
9281Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
9282as well as reading.
c906108c
SS
9283@end table
9284
6d2ebf8b 9285@node GDB Files
c906108c
SS
9286@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
9287
7a292a7a
SS
9288@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
9289both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
9290program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
9291@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
c906108c
SS
9292
9293@menu
9294* Files:: Commands to specify files
9295* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
9296@end menu
9297
6d2ebf8b 9298@node Files
c906108c 9299@section Commands to specify files
c906108c 9300
7a292a7a 9301@cindex symbol table
c906108c 9302@cindex core dump file
7a292a7a
SS
9303
9304You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
9305way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
9306@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
9307Out of @value{GDBN}}).
c906108c
SS
9308
9309Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
9310@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
9311a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
9312to specify new files are useful.
9313
9314@table @code
9315@cindex executable file
9316@kindex file
9317@item file @var{filename}
9318Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
9319symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
9320executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
5d161b24
DB
9321directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
9322@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
9323directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
9324to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
9325and your program, using the @code{path} command.
9326
6d2ebf8b 9327On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
c906108c
SS
9328@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
9329@var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
9330@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
9331descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
9332(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
5d161b24 9333@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
c906108c 9334for more information.
c906108c
SS
9335
9336@item file
9337@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
9338has on both executable file and the symbol table.
9339
9340@kindex exec-file
9341@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9342Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
9343in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
9344if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
9345discard information on the executable file.
9346
9347@kindex symbol-file
9348@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9349Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
9350searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
9351table and program to run from the same file.
9352
9353@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
9354program's symbol table.
9355
5d161b24 9356The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
c906108c
SS
9357of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
9358auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
9359the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
9360the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
9361
9362@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
9363executing it once.
9364
9365When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
9366understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
9367generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
9368other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
c906108c
SS
9369Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
9370using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
9371optimized code.
c906108c
SS
9372
9373For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
9374using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
9375symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
9376quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
9377details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
9378
9379The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
9380start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
9381occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
9382file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
9383pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
9384warnings and messages}.)
9385
c906108c
SS
9386We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
9387symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
9388symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
9389still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
9390in stabs format.
9391
9392@kindex readnow
9393@cindex reading symbols immediately
9394@cindex symbols, reading immediately
9395@kindex mapped
9396@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
9397@cindex saving symbol table
9398@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9399@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9400You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
9401tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
9402load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
5d161b24 9403entire symbol table available.
c906108c 9404
c906108c
SS
9405If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
9406@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
9407cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
9408file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
9409from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
9410than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
9411program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
9412starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
9413
9414You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
9415file has all the symbol information for your program.
9416
9417The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
9418@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
9419than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
9420it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
9421needed.
9422
9423The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
9424@value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
9425symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c
SS
9426
9427@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
9428@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
9429@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
9430@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
9431@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
9432@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
9433@c files.
9434
9435@kindex core
9436@kindex core-file
9437@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9438Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
9439of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
9440address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
9441executable file itself for other parts.
9442
9443@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
9444to be used.
9445
9446Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7a292a7a
SS
9447under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
9448wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
9449the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
c906108c 9450(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
c906108c 9451
c906108c
SS
9452@kindex add-symbol-file
9453@cindex dynamic linking
9454@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
9455@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
17d9d558 9456@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
96a2c332
SS
9457The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
9458information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
9459when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
9460into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
9461address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
d167840f
EZ
9462this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
9463of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
9464section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
9465@var{address} as an expression.
c906108c
SS
9466
9467The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
9468originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
96a2c332
SS
9469@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
9470thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
9471instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
c906108c 9472
17d9d558
JB
9473@cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
9474@cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
9475@cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
9476@cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
9477@cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
9478Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
9479executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
9480relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
9481information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
9482
9483@itemize @bullet
9484@item
9485the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
9486that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
9487@item
9488every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
9489been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
9490@item
9491you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
9492provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9493@end itemize
9494
9495@noindent
9496Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
9497relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
9498typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
9499important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
9500procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C++ constructor table
9501assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
9502general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
9503relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
9504as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
9505way.
9506
c906108c
SS
9507@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9508
9509You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
9510the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
9511table information for @var{filename}.
9512
9513@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
9514@item add-shared-symbol-file
9515The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
5d161b24
DB
9516operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
9517shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
c906108c 9518@code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
c906108c 9519
c906108c
SS
9520@kindex section
9521@item section
5d161b24
DB
9522The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
9523the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
9524section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
9525specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
d4f3574e
SS
9526separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
9527the sections and their addresses.
c906108c
SS
9528
9529@kindex info files
9530@kindex info target
9531@item info files
9532@itemx info target
7a292a7a
SS
9533@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
9534current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
9535including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
9536use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
9537command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
9538current ones.
9539
fe95c787
MS
9540@kindex maint info sections
9541@item maint info sections
9542Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
9543is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
9544displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
9545offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
9546@code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
9547may be arbitrarily combined):
9548
9549@table @code
9550@item ALLOBJ
9551Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
9552@item @var{sections}
6600abed 9553Display info only for named @var{sections}.
fe95c787
MS
9554@item @var{section-flags}
9555Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
9556The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
9557@table @code
9558@item ALLOC
9559Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
9560Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
9561@item LOAD
9562Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
9563Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
9564@item RELOC
9565Section needs to be relocated before loading.
9566@item READONLY
9567Section cannot be modified by the child process.
9568@item CODE
9569Section contains executable code only.
6600abed 9570@item DATA
fe95c787
MS
9571Section contains data only (no executable code).
9572@item ROM
9573Section will reside in ROM.
9574@item CONSTRUCTOR
9575Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
9576@item HAS_CONTENTS
9577Section is not empty.
9578@item NEVER_LOAD
9579An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
9580@item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
9581A notification to the linker that the section contains
9582COFF shared library information.
9583@item IS_COMMON
9584Section contains common symbols.
9585@end table
9586@end table
6763aef9
MS
9587@kindex set trust-readonly-sections
9588@item set trust-readonly-sections on
9589Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
6ca652b0 9590really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
6763aef9
MS
9591In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
9592out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
9593For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
9594enhancement to debugging performance.
9595
9596The default is off.
9597
9598@item set trust-readonly-sections off
15110bc3 9599Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
6763aef9
MS
9600the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
9601and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
c906108c
SS
9602@end table
9603
9604All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
9605as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
9606name and remembers it that way.
9607
c906108c 9608@cindex shared libraries
c906108c
SS
9609@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
9610libraries.
53a5351d 9611
c906108c
SS
9612@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
9613when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
9614(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
9615references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
9616debugging a core file).
53a5351d
JM
9617
9618On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
9619automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
9620
c906108c
SS
9621@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
9622@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
9623@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
9624
b7209cb4
FF
9625There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
9626symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
9627particularly large or there are many of them.
9628
9629To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
9630commands:
9631
9632@table @code
9633@kindex set auto-solib-add
9634@item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
9635If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
9636will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
9637attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
9638informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
9639is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
9640@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
9641
9642@kindex show auto-solib-add
9643@item show auto-solib-add
9644Display the current autoloading mode.
9645@end table
9646
9647To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
9648command:
9649
c906108c
SS
9650@table @code
9651@kindex info sharedlibrary
9652@kindex info share
9653@item info share
9654@itemx info sharedlibrary
9655Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
9656
9657@kindex sharedlibrary
9658@kindex share
9659@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
9660@itemx share @var{regex}
c906108c
SS
9661Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
9662Unix regular expression.
9663As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
9664required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
9665@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
9666loaded.
9667@end table
9668
b7209cb4
FF
9669On some systems, such as HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} supports
9670autoloading shared library symbols until a limiting threshold size is
9671reached. This provides the benefit of allowing autoloading to remain on
9672by default, but avoids autoloading excessively large shared libraries,
9673up to a threshold that is initially set, but which you can modify if you
9674wish.
c906108c
SS
9675
9676Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
d4f3574e
SS
9677loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
9678@var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
c906108c
SS
9679automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
9680
9681To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
9682
9683@table @code
b7209cb4
FF
9684@kindex set auto-solib-limit
9685@item set auto-solib-limit @var{threshold}
9686Set the autoloading size threshold, in an integral number of megabytes.
9687If @var{threshold} is nonzero and shared library autoloading is enabled,
9688symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded until the total
9689size of the loaded shared library symbols exceeds this threshold.
c906108c 9690Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
6ca652b0 9691@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 (i.e.@: 100
b7209cb4 9692Mb).
c906108c 9693
b7209cb4
FF
9694@kindex show auto-solib-limit
9695@item show auto-solib-limit
c906108c
SS
9696Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
9697@end table
c906108c 9698
6d2ebf8b 9699@node Symbol Errors
c906108c
SS
9700@section Errors reading symbol files
9701
9702While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
9703such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
9704output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
9705they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
9706debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
9707about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
9708only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
9709times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
9710to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
9711complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9712messages}).
9713
9714The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
9715
9716@table @code
9717@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
9718
9719The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
9720(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
9721error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
9722in its outer scope blocks.
9723
9724@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
9725the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
9726may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
9727function.
9728
9729@item block at @var{address} out of order
9730
9731The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
9732order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
9733do so.
9734
9735@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
9736locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
9737can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
9738@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9739messages}.)
9740
9741@item bad block start address patched
9742
9743The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
9744smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
9745to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
9746
9747@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
9748starting on the previous source line.
9749
9750@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
9751
9752@cindex foo
9753Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
9754larger than the size of the string table.
9755
9756@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
9757name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
9758with this name.
9759
9760@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
9761
7a292a7a
SS
9762The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
9763not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
d4f3574e 9764uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
c906108c 9765
7a292a7a
SS
9766@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
9767This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
c906108c 9768are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7a292a7a
SS
9769debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
9770on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
9771and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
c906108c
SS
9772
9773@item stub type has NULL name
c906108c 9774
7a292a7a 9775@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
c906108c 9776
7a292a7a 9777@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
b37052ae 9778The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
7a292a7a
SS
9779information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
9780it.
c906108c
SS
9781
9782@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
9783
9784@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7a292a7a 9785
c906108c
SS
9786@end table
9787
6d2ebf8b 9788@node Targets
c906108c 9789@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7a292a7a 9790
c906108c
SS
9791@cindex debugging target
9792@kindex target
9793
9794A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
53a5351d
JM
9795
9796Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
9797in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
9798you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
c906108c
SS
9799flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
9800host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
53a5351d
JM
9801realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
9802command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
9803(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
c906108c
SS
9804
9805@menu
9806* Active Targets:: Active targets
9807* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
c906108c
SS
9808* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
9809* Remote:: Remote debugging
96baa820 9810* KOD:: Kernel Object Display
c906108c
SS
9811
9812@end menu
9813
6d2ebf8b 9814@node Active Targets
c906108c 9815@section Active targets
7a292a7a 9816
c906108c
SS
9817@cindex stacking targets
9818@cindex active targets
9819@cindex multiple targets
9820
c906108c 9821There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7a292a7a
SS
9822executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
9823active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
9824start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
9825a core file.
c906108c
SS
9826
9827For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
9828@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
9829well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
9830@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
9831first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
9832requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
9833are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
9834read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
9835executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
c906108c
SS
9836
9837When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7a292a7a
SS
9838target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
9839commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
9840an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
9841process target is active.
c906108c 9842
7a292a7a
SS
9843Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
9844core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
c906108c 9845files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7a292a7a
SS
9846the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
9847process}).
c906108c 9848
6d2ebf8b 9849@node Target Commands
c906108c
SS
9850@section Commands for managing targets
9851
9852@table @code
9853@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7a292a7a
SS
9854Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
9855process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
9856facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
9857protocol of the target machine.
c906108c
SS
9858
9859Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
9860typically include things like device names or host names to connect
9861with, process numbers, and baud rates.
c906108c
SS
9862
9863The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
9864after executing the command.
9865
9866@kindex help target
9867@item help target
9868Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
9869currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
9870(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
9871
9872@item help target @var{name}
9873Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
9874select it.
9875
9876@kindex set gnutarget
9877@item set gnutarget @var{args}
5d161b24 9878@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
c906108c 9879knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
5d161b24
DB
9880a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
9881with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
c906108c
SS
9882with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
9883
d4f3574e 9884@quotation
c906108c
SS
9885@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
9886you must know the actual BFD name.
d4f3574e 9887@end quotation
c906108c 9888
d4f3574e
SS
9889@noindent
9890@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
c906108c 9891
5d161b24 9892@kindex show gnutarget
c906108c
SS
9893@item show gnutarget
9894Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
9895@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
9896@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
9897and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
9898@end table
9899
c906108c
SS
9900Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
9901configuration):
c906108c
SS
9902
9903@table @code
9904@kindex target exec
9905@item target exec @var{program}
9906An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
9907@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
9908
c906108c
SS
9909@kindex target core
9910@item target core @var{filename}
9911A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
9912@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
c906108c
SS
9913
9914@kindex target remote
9915@item target remote @var{dev}
9916Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
9917specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
9918@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 9919supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
c906108c
SS
9920some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
9921it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
9922
c906108c
SS
9923@kindex target sim
9924@item target sim
2df3850c 9925Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
104c1213 9926In general,
474c8240 9927@smallexample
104c1213
JM
9928 target sim
9929 load
9930 run
474c8240 9931@end smallexample
d4f3574e 9932@noindent
104c1213 9933works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
d4f3574e 9934drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
104c1213
JM
9935provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
9936see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
9937Processors}.
9938
c906108c
SS
9939@end table
9940
104c1213 9941Some configurations may include these targets as well:
c906108c
SS
9942
9943@table @code
9944
c906108c
SS
9945@kindex target nrom
9946@item target nrom @var{dev}
9947NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
9948
c906108c
SS
9949@end table
9950
5d161b24 9951Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
c906108c 9952your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
c906108c
SS
9953
9954Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
9955once you've successfully established a connection.
9956
9957@table @code
9958
9959@kindex load @var{filename}
9960@item load @var{filename}
c906108c
SS
9961Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
9962@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
9963is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
9964on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
9965@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
9966the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9967
9968If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
9969execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
9970target is @dots{}}''
c906108c
SS
9971
9972The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
9973For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
9974link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
9975specifies a fixed address.
9976@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
9977
c906108c
SS
9978@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9979@end table
9980
6d2ebf8b 9981@node Byte Order
c906108c 9982@section Choosing target byte order
7a292a7a 9983
c906108c
SS
9984@cindex choosing target byte order
9985@cindex target byte order
c906108c
SS
9986
9987Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
9988offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
9989orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
9990designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
9991which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
d4f3574e 9992@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
c906108c
SS
9993
9994@table @code
9995@kindex set endian big
9996@item set endian big
9997Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
9998
9999@kindex set endian little
10000@item set endian little
10001Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
10002
10003@kindex set endian auto
10004@item set endian auto
10005Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
10006executable.
10007
10008@item show endian
10009Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
10010
10011@end table
10012
10013Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
10014data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
10015target system.
10016
6d2ebf8b 10017@node Remote
c906108c
SS
10018@section Remote debugging
10019@cindex remote debugging
10020
10021If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
5d161b24
DB
10022@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
10023For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
c906108c
SS
10024or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
10025powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
10026
10027Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
10028to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
5d161b24 10029@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
c906108c
SS
10030but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
10031write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
10032communicate with @value{GDBN}.
10033
10034Other remote targets may be available in your
10035configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
c906108c 10036
6f05cf9f
AC
10037@node KOD
10038@section Kernel Object Display
10039
10040@cindex kernel object display
10041@cindex kernel object
10042@cindex KOD
10043
10044Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
10045@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
10046and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
10047mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
10048displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
10049
10050Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
10051@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
10052
474c8240 10053@smallexample
6f05cf9f 10054(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
474c8240 10055@end smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10056
10057If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
10058about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
10059which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
10060after the operating system:
c906108c 10061
474c8240 10062@smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10063(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
10064List of Cisco Kernel Objects
10065Object Description
10066any Any and all objects
474c8240 10067@end smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10068
10069Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
10070by the kernel.
10071
10072There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
10073is supported other than to try it.
10074
10075
10076@node Remote Debugging
10077@chapter Debugging remote programs
10078
6b2f586d
AC
10079@menu
10080* Server:: Using the gdbserver program
10081* NetWare:: Using the gdbserve.nlm program
10082* remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
6b2f586d
AC
10083@end menu
10084
6f05cf9f
AC
10085@node Server
10086@section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
10087
10088@kindex gdbserver
10089@cindex remote connection without stubs
10090@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
10091allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10092@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
10093
10094@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
10095because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
10096that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
10097@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
10098@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
10099because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
10100also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
10101started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
10102Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
10103the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
10104do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
10105by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
10106choice for debugging.
10107
10108@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
10109or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
10110protocol.
10111
10112@table @emph
10113@item On the target machine,
10114you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10115@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
10116strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
10117system does all the symbol handling.
10118
10119To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
56460a61 10120the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
6f05cf9f
AC
10121syntax is:
10122
10123@smallexample
10124target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10125@end smallexample
10126
10127@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
10128hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
10129@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
10130@file{/dev/com1}:
10131
10132@smallexample
10133target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
10134@end smallexample
10135
10136@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
10137with it.
10138
10139To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
10140
10141@smallexample
10142target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
10143@end smallexample
10144
10145The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
10146specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
10147TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
10148expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
10149(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
10150you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
10151TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
10152reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
10153conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
10154and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
10155@code{target remote} command.
10156
56460a61
DJ
10157On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
10158This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
10159
10160@smallexample
10161target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
10162@end smallexample
10163
10164@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
10165to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
10166
6f05cf9f
AC
10167@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10168you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10169symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10170using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10171(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10172running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
10173remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
10174is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
10175@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
10176@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
10177
10178@smallexample
10179(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10180@end smallexample
10181
10182@noindent
10183communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
10184
10185@smallexample
10186(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
10187@end smallexample
10188
10189@noindent
10190communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
10191For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
10192the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
10193text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
10194@samp{Connection refused}.
10195@end table
10196
10197@node NetWare
10198@section Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
10199
10200@kindex gdbserve.nlm
10201@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
10202allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10203@code{target remote}.
10204
10205@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
10206using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
10207
10208@table @emph
10209@item On the target machine,
10210you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10211@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
10212can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
10213host system does all the symbol handling.
10214
10215To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
10216@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
10217program. The syntax is:
10218
10219@smallexample
10220load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
10221 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10222@end smallexample
10223
10224@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
10225the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
10226to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
10227
10228For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
10229communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
10230using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
10231
10232@smallexample
10233load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
10234@end smallexample
10235
10236@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10237you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10238symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10239using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10240(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10241running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
10242remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
10243argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
10244@file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
10245
10246@smallexample
10247(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10248@end smallexample
10249
10250@noindent
10251communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
10252@end table
10253
10254@node remote stub
10255@section Implementing a remote stub
7a292a7a 10256
8e04817f
AC
10257@cindex debugging stub, example
10258@cindex remote stub, example
10259@cindex stub example, remote debugging
10260The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
10261communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
10262@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
10263these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
10264implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
10265with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
10266organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
10267
104c1213
JM
10268@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
10269To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
10270@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
10271prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
10272program, you need:
c906108c 10273
104c1213
JM
10274@enumerate
10275@item
10276A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
10277have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
10278your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
96baa820 10279
5d161b24 10280@item
d4f3574e 10281A C subroutine library to support your program's
104c1213 10282subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
96baa820 10283
104c1213
JM
10284@item
10285A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
10286download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
10287manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
10288documentation.
10289@end enumerate
96baa820 10290
104c1213
JM
10291The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
10292communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
10293machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
96baa820 10294
104c1213
JM
10295@table @emph
10296@item On the host,
10297@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
10298else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
10299(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
10300
10301@item On the target,
10302you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
10303implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
10304subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
10305
10306On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
10307@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
10308@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
10309@end table
96baa820 10310
104c1213
JM
10311The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
10312machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
10313@sc{sparc} boards.
96baa820 10314
104c1213
JM
10315@cindex remote serial stub list
10316These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
96baa820 10317
104c1213
JM
10318@table @code
10319
10320@item i386-stub.c
41afff9a 10321@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10322@cindex Intel
10323@cindex i386
10324For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
10325
10326@item m68k-stub.c
41afff9a 10327@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10328@cindex Motorola 680x0
10329@cindex m680x0
10330For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
10331
10332@item sh-stub.c
41afff9a 10333@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10334@cindex Hitachi
10335@cindex SH
10336For Hitachi SH architectures.
10337
10338@item sparc-stub.c
41afff9a 10339@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10340@cindex Sparc
10341For @sc{sparc} architectures.
10342
10343@item sparcl-stub.c
41afff9a 10344@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10345@cindex Fujitsu
10346@cindex SparcLite
10347For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
10348
10349@end table
10350
10351The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
10352recently added stubs.
10353
10354@menu
10355* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
10356* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
10357* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
104c1213
JM
10358@end menu
10359
6d2ebf8b 10360@node Stub Contents
6f05cf9f 10361@subsection What the stub can do for you
104c1213
JM
10362
10363@cindex remote serial stub
10364The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
10365subroutines:
10366
10367@table @code
10368@item set_debug_traps
10369@kindex set_debug_traps
10370@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
10371This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
10372program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
10373beginning of your program.
10374
10375@item handle_exception
10376@kindex handle_exception
10377@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
10378This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
10379explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
10380run when a trap is triggered.
10381
10382@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
10383execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
10384with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
10385protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
d4f3574e 10386representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
104c1213
JM
10387information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
10388retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
10389execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
10390@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
5d161b24 10391machine.
104c1213
JM
10392
10393@item breakpoint
10394@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
10395Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
10396breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
10397way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
10398machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
10399pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
10400@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
10401simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
10402again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
10403your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
5d161b24 10404@value{GDBN} session gets control.
104c1213
JM
10405
10406Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
10407to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
10408start of your debugging session.
10409@end table
10410
6d2ebf8b 10411@node Bootstrapping
6f05cf9f 10412@subsection What you must do for the stub
104c1213
JM
10413
10414@cindex remote stub, support routines
10415The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
10416chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
10417debugging target machine.
10418
10419First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
10420serial port.
10421
10422@table @code
10423@item int getDebugChar()
10424@kindex getDebugChar
10425Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
10426It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
10427different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10428
10429@item void putDebugChar(int)
10430@kindex putDebugChar
10431Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
5d161b24 10432It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
104c1213
JM
10433different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10434@end table
10435
10436@cindex control C, and remote debugging
10437@cindex interrupting remote targets
10438If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
10439running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
10440for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
10441character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
10442remote system to stop.
10443
10444Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
10445probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
10446is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
10447@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
10448
10449Other routines you need to supply are:
10450
10451@table @code
10452@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
10453@kindex exceptionHandler
10454Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
10455handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
10456way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
10457are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
10458containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
10459@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
10460its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
10461might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
10462exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
10463@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
10464and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
10465you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
10466should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
10467
10468For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
10469gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
10470should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
10471@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
10472help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
10473
10474@item void flush_i_cache()
10475@kindex flush_i_cache
d4f3574e 10476On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
104c1213
JM
10477instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
10478instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
10479
10480On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
10481function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
10482@end table
10483
10484@noindent
10485You must also make sure this library routine is available:
10486
10487@table @code
10488@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
10489@kindex memset
10490This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
10491memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
10492@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
10493either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
10494@end table
10495
10496If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
10497library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
10498but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
d4f3574e 10499subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
104c1213
JM
10500
10501
6d2ebf8b 10502@node Debug Session
6f05cf9f 10503@subsection Putting it all together
104c1213
JM
10504
10505@cindex remote serial debugging summary
10506In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
10507steps.
10508
10509@enumerate
10510@item
6d2ebf8b 10511Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
104c1213
JM
10512(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
10513@display
10514@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
10515@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
10516@end display
10517
10518@item
10519Insert these lines near the top of your program:
10520
474c8240 10521@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10522set_debug_traps();
10523breakpoint();
474c8240 10524@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10525
10526@item
10527For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
10528@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
10529
474c8240 10530@smallexample
104c1213 10531void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
474c8240 10532@end smallexample
104c1213 10533
d4f3574e 10534@noindent
104c1213 10535but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
598ca718 10536function in your program, that function is called when
104c1213
JM
10537@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
10538error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
10539one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
10540
10541@item
10542Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
10543your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
10544
10545@item
10546Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
10547the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
10548
10549@item
10550@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
10551@c document that. FIXME.
10552Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
10553whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
10554
10555@item
10556To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
10557as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
10558This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
10559of its pure text.
10560
d4f3574e 10561@item
104c1213 10562@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 10563Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
104c1213
JM
10564Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
10565machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
9db8d71f 10566TCP or UDP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
104c1213
JM
10567to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
10568device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
10569
474c8240 10570@smallexample
104c1213 10571target remote /dev/ttyb
474c8240 10572@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10573
10574@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
10575To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
9db8d71f
DJ
10576@code{@var{host}:@var{port}} or @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}.
10577For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
104c1213
JM
10578terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10579
474c8240 10580@smallexample
104c1213 10581target remote manyfarms:2828
474c8240 10582@end smallexample
a2bea4c3
CV
10583
10584If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as
10585your debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator of your target running on
10586the same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect
10587to port 1234 on your local machine:
10588
474c8240 10589@smallexample
a2bea4c3 10590target remote :1234
474c8240 10591@end smallexample
a2bea4c3
CV
10592@noindent
10593
10594Note that the colon is still required here.
9db8d71f
DJ
10595
10596@cindex UDP port, @code{target remote}
10597To use a UDP connection, use an argument of the form
10598@code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}. For example, to connect to UDP port 2828
10599on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10600
10601@smallexample
10602target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
10603@end smallexample
10604
10605When using a UDP connection for remote debugging, you should keep in mind
10606that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. UDP can silently drop packets on
10607busy or unreliable networks, which will cause havoc with your debugging
10608session.
10609
104c1213
JM
10610@end enumerate
10611
10612Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
10613step and continue the remote program.
10614
10615To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
10616command.
10617
10618@cindex interrupting remote programs
10619@cindex remote programs, interrupting
10620Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
10621interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
10622program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
10623and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
10624interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
10625
474c8240 10626@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10627Interrupted while waiting for the program.
10628Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
474c8240 10629@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10630
10631If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
10632(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
10633remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
10634goes back to waiting.
10635
104c1213 10636
8e04817f
AC
10637@node Configurations
10638@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
104c1213 10639
8e04817f
AC
10640While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
10641cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
10642describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
104c1213 10643
8e04817f
AC
10644There are three major categories of configurations: native
10645configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
10646operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
10647different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
10648are quite different from each other.
104c1213 10649
8e04817f
AC
10650@menu
10651* Native::
10652* Embedded OS::
10653* Embedded Processors::
10654* Architectures::
10655@end menu
104c1213 10656
8e04817f
AC
10657@node Native
10658@section Native
104c1213 10659
8e04817f
AC
10660This section describes details specific to particular native
10661configurations.
6cf7e474 10662
8e04817f
AC
10663@menu
10664* HP-UX:: HP-UX
10665* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
10666* DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
78c47bea 10667* Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
8e04817f 10668@end menu
6cf7e474 10669
8e04817f
AC
10670@node HP-UX
10671@subsection HP-UX
104c1213 10672
8e04817f
AC
10673On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10674begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10675name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
104c1213 10676
8e04817f
AC
10677@node SVR4 Process Information
10678@subsection SVR4 process information
104c1213 10679
8e04817f
AC
10680@kindex /proc
10681@cindex process image
104c1213 10682
8e04817f
AC
10683Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
10684used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
10685subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
10686this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
10687several kinds of information about the process running your program.
10688@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
10689@code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
1104b9e7 10690and Unixware, but not HP-UX or @sc{gnu}/Linux, for example.
104c1213 10691
8e04817f
AC
10692@table @code
10693@kindex info proc
10694@item info proc
10695Summarize available information about the process.
6cf7e474 10696
8e04817f
AC
10697@kindex info proc mappings
10698@item info proc mappings
10699Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
10700on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
10701@ignore
10702@comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
10703@comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
10704@comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
10705@kindex info proc times
10706@item info proc times
10707Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
10708its children.
6cf7e474 10709
8e04817f
AC
10710@kindex info proc id
10711@item info proc id
10712Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
10713the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
104c1213 10714
8e04817f
AC
10715@kindex info proc status
10716@item info proc status
10717General information on the state of the process. If the process is
10718stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
10719received.
d4f3574e 10720
8e04817f
AC
10721@item info proc all
10722Show all the above information about the process.
10723@end ignore
10724@end table
104c1213 10725
8e04817f
AC
10726@node DJGPP Native
10727@subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
10728@cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
10729@cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
10730@cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
104c1213 10731
8e04817f
AC
10732@sc{djgpp} is the port of @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
10733MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
10734that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
10735top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
104c1213 10736
8e04817f
AC
10737@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
10738defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
10739subsection describes those commands.
104c1213 10740
8e04817f
AC
10741@table @code
10742@kindex info dos
10743@item info dos
10744This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
10745information about the target system and important OS structures.
f1251bdd 10746
8e04817f
AC
10747@kindex sysinfo
10748@cindex MS-DOS system info
10749@cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
10750@item info dos sysinfo
10751This command displays assorted information about the underlying
10752platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
10753DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
104c1213 10754
8e04817f
AC
10755@cindex GDT
10756@cindex LDT
10757@cindex IDT
10758@cindex segment descriptor tables
10759@cindex descriptor tables display
10760@item info dos gdt
10761@itemx info dos ldt
10762@itemx info dos idt
10763These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
10764and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
10765tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
10766that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
10767descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
10768descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
10769rights.
104c1213 10770
8e04817f
AC
10771A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
10772segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
10773allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
10774conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
10775additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
d4f3574e 10776
8e04817f
AC
10777@cindex garbled pointers
10778These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
10779Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
10780displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
10781display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
10782example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
10783debugged program's data segment:
104c1213 10784
8e04817f
AC
10785@smallexample
10786@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
10787@exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
10788@end smallexample
104c1213 10789
8e04817f
AC
10790@noindent
10791This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
10792the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
104c1213 10793
8e04817f
AC
10794@cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
10795@item info dos pde
10796@itemx info dos pte
10797These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
10798Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
10799data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
10800into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
10801page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
10802may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
10803Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
10804that is currently in use.
104c1213 10805
8e04817f
AC
10806Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
10807Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
10808the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
10809@kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
10810Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
10811means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
10812the specified entry in the Page Directory.
104c1213 10813
8e04817f
AC
10814@cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
10815These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
10816Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
10817controller.
104c1213 10818
8e04817f 10819These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
104c1213 10820
8e04817f
AC
10821@cindex physical address from linear address
10822@item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
10823This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
10824address. The argument linear address @var{addr} should already have the
10825appropriate segment's base address added to it, because this command
10826accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any} segment. For
10827example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for the page where
10828the variable @code{i} is stored:
104c1213 10829
8e04817f
AC
10830@smallexample
10831@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
10832@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
10833@exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
10834@end smallexample
104c1213 10835
8e04817f
AC
10836@noindent
10837This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
10838whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and prints all the
10839attributes of that page.
104c1213 10840
8e04817f
AC
10841Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
10842since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
10843address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
10844be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
10845declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
10846@code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
104c1213 10847
8e04817f
AC
10848Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
10849transfer buffer:
104c1213 10850
8e04817f
AC
10851@smallexample
10852@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
10853@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
10854@exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
10855@end smallexample
104c1213 10856
8e04817f
AC
10857@noindent
10858(The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
108593rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output of
10860this command clearly shows that addresses in conventional memory are
10861mapped 1:1, i.e.@: the physical and linear addresses are identical.
104c1213 10862
8e04817f
AC
10863This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
10864@end table
104c1213 10865
78c47bea
PM
10866@node Cygwin Native
10867@subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
10868@cindex MS Windows debugging
10869@cindex native Cygwin debugging
10870@cindex Cygwin-specific commands
10871
10872@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, and
10873defines a few commands specific to the Cygwin port. This
10874subsection describes those commands.
10875
10876@table @code
10877@kindex info w32
10878@item info w32
10879This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
10880information about the target system and important OS structures.
10881
10882@item info w32 selector
10883This command displays information returned by
10884the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
10885It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
10886a long value to give the information about this given selector.
10887Without argument, this command displays information
10888about the the six segment registers.
10889
10890@kindex info dll
10891@item info dll
10892This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
10893
10894@kindex dll-symbols
10895@item dll-symbols
10896This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
10897add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
10898
10899@kindex set new-console
10900@item set new-console @var{mode}
10901If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
10902be started in a new console on next start.
10903If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
10904be started in the same console as the debugger.
10905
10906@kindex show new-console
10907@item show new-console
10908Displays whether a new console is used
10909when the debuggee is started.
10910
10911@kindex set new-group
10912@item set new-group @var{mode}
10913This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
10914start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
10915This affects the way the Windows OS handles
10916Ctrl-C.
10917
10918@kindex show new-group
10919@item show new-group
10920Displays current value of new-group boolean.
10921
10922@kindex set debugevents
10923@item set debugevents
10924This boolean value adds debug output concerning events seen by the debugger.
10925
10926@kindex set debugexec
10927@item set debugexec
10928This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
10929seen by the debugger.
10930
10931@kindex set debugexceptions
10932@item set debugexceptions
10933This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning exception events
10934seen by the debugger.
10935
10936@kindex set debugmemory
10937@item set debugmemory
10938This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning memory events
10939seen by the debugger.
10940
10941@kindex set shell
10942@item set shell
10943This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
10944via a shell or directly (default value is on).
10945
10946@kindex show shell
10947@item show shell
10948Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
10949
10950@end table
10951
8e04817f
AC
10952@node Embedded OS
10953@section Embedded Operating Systems
104c1213 10954
8e04817f
AC
10955This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
10956embedded operating systems that are available for several different
10957architectures.
d4f3574e 10958
8e04817f
AC
10959@menu
10960* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
10961@end menu
104c1213 10962
8e04817f
AC
10963@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
10964various real-time operating systems.
104c1213 10965
8e04817f
AC
10966@node VxWorks
10967@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
104c1213 10968
8e04817f 10969@cindex VxWorks
104c1213 10970
8e04817f 10971@table @code
104c1213 10972
8e04817f
AC
10973@kindex target vxworks
10974@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
10975A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
10976is the target system's machine name or IP address.
104c1213 10977
8e04817f 10978@end table
104c1213 10979
8e04817f
AC
10980On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
10981current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
104c1213 10982
8e04817f
AC
10983@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
10984VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
10985the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
10986both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
10987@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
10988installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
10989@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
104c1213 10990
8e04817f
AC
10991@table @code
10992@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
10993@kindex vxworks-timeout
10994All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
10995This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
10996seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
10997your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
10998of a thin network line.
10999@end table
104c1213 11000
8e04817f
AC
11001The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
11002this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
11003procedures.
104c1213 11004
8e04817f
AC
11005@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
11006To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
11007to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
11008library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
11009VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
11010kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
11011source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
11012information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
11013manual.
11014@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
104c1213 11015
8e04817f
AC
11016Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
11017your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11018run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
11019@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213 11020
8e04817f 11021@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
104c1213 11022
474c8240 11023@smallexample
8e04817f 11024(vxgdb)
474c8240 11025@end smallexample
104c1213 11026
8e04817f
AC
11027@menu
11028* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
11029* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
11030* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
11031@end menu
104c1213 11032
8e04817f
AC
11033@node VxWorks Connection
11034@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
104c1213 11035
8e04817f
AC
11036The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
11037network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
104c1213 11038
474c8240 11039@smallexample
8e04817f 11040(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
474c8240 11041@end smallexample
104c1213 11042
8e04817f
AC
11043@need 750
11044@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
104c1213 11045
8e04817f
AC
11046@smallexample
11047Attaching remote machine across net...
11048Connected to tt.
11049@end smallexample
104c1213 11050
8e04817f
AC
11051@need 1000
11052@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
11053loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
11054these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
11055path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
11056to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
5d161b24 11057
474c8240 11058@smallexample
8e04817f 11059prog.o: No such file or directory.
474c8240 11060@end smallexample
104c1213 11061
8e04817f
AC
11062When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
11063the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
11064command again.
104c1213 11065
8e04817f
AC
11066@node VxWorks Download
11067@subsubsection VxWorks download
104c1213 11068
8e04817f
AC
11069@cindex download to VxWorks
11070If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
11071object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
11072@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
11073incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
11074command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
11075to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
11076table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
11077the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
11078filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
11079Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
11080to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
11081the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
11082@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
11083and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
11084program, type this on VxWorks:
104c1213 11085
474c8240 11086@smallexample
8e04817f 11087-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
474c8240 11088@end smallexample
104c1213 11089
8e04817f
AC
11090@noindent
11091Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
104c1213 11092
474c8240 11093@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11094(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
11095(vxgdb) load prog.o
474c8240 11096@end smallexample
104c1213 11097
8e04817f 11098@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
104c1213 11099
8e04817f
AC
11100@smallexample
11101Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
11102@end smallexample
104c1213 11103
8e04817f
AC
11104You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
11105after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
11106this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
11107auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
11108history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
11109debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
11110table.)
104c1213 11111
8e04817f
AC
11112@node VxWorks Attach
11113@subsubsection Running tasks
104c1213
JM
11114
11115@cindex running VxWorks tasks
11116You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
11117follows:
11118
474c8240 11119@smallexample
104c1213 11120(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
474c8240 11121@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
11122
11123@noindent
11124where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
11125or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
11126the time of attachment.
11127
6d2ebf8b 11128@node Embedded Processors
104c1213
JM
11129@section Embedded Processors
11130
11131This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
11132configurations.
11133
7d86b5d5 11134
104c1213 11135@menu
104c1213
JM
11136* ARM:: ARM
11137* H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
11138* H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
11139* i960:: Intel i960
11140* M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
11141* M68K:: Motorola M68K
104c1213 11142* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
a37295f9 11143* OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
104c1213
JM
11144* PA:: HP PA Embedded
11145* PowerPC: PowerPC
11146* SH:: Hitachi SH
11147* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
11148* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
11149* ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
11150* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
11151@end menu
11152
6d2ebf8b 11153@node ARM
104c1213
JM
11154@subsection ARM
11155
11156@table @code
11157
8e04817f
AC
11158@kindex target rdi
11159@item target rdi @var{dev}
11160ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
11161use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
11162monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
11163
11164@kindex target rdp
11165@item target rdp @var{dev}
11166ARM Demon monitor.
11167
11168@end table
11169
11170@node H8/300
11171@subsection Hitachi H8/300
11172
11173@table @code
11174
11175@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
11176@item target hms @var{dev}
11177A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
11178Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
11179line and the communications speed used.
11180
11181@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
11182@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11183E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
11184
11185@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
11186@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
11187@item target sh3 @var{dev}
11188@itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
11189Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11190
11191@end table
11192
11193@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
11194@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
11195@cindex download to Hitachi SH
11196@cindex Hitachi SH download
11197When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
11198board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
11199board and also opens it as the current executable target for
11200@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
11201
11202@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
11203Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
11204
11205@enumerate
11206@item
11207that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
11208for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
11209emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
11210the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
11211H8/300, or H8/500.)
11212
11213@item
11214what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
11215serial device available on your host is the default).
11216
11217@item
11218what speed to use over the serial device.
11219@end enumerate
11220
11221@menu
11222* Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
11223* Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
11224* Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
11225@end menu
11226
11227@node Hitachi Boards
11228@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
11229
11230@c only for Unix hosts
11231@kindex device
11232@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
11233Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
11234need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
11235first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
11236hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
11237
11238@kindex speed
11239@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
11240@code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
11241speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
11242hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
11243the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
11244@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
11245
11246The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
11247use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
11248use a DOS host,
11249@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
11250called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
11251through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
11252to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
11253
11254The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
11255program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
11256sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
11257the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
11258
11259First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
11260board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
11261port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
11262When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
11263debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
11264for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
11265@code{COM2}.
11266
474c8240 11267@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11268C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
11269C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
11270
11271Resident portion of MODE loaded
11272
11273COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
11274
474c8240 11275@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11276
11277@quotation
11278@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
11279@code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
11280disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
11281your development board.
11282@end quotation
11283
11284@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
11285Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
11286connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
11287the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
11288you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
11289commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
11290cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
11291download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
11292the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
11293(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
11294executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
11295@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
11296itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
11297
11298@smallexample
11299(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
11300@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
11301 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
11302 the conditions.
11303There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
11304for details.
11305@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
11306(@value{GDBP}) target hms
11307Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
11308(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
11309.text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
11310.data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
11311.stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
11312@end smallexample
11313
11314At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
11315you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
11316sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
11317@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
11318resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
11319@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
11320
11321Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
11322available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
11323you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
11324
11325Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
11326@itemize @bullet
11327@item
11328to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
11329no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
11330
11331@item
11332to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
11333normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
11334to detect program completion.
11335@end itemize
11336
11337In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
11338development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
11339
11340@node Hitachi ICE
11341@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
11342
11343@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
11344You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
11345Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
11346e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
11347
11348@table @code
11349@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
11350Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
11351@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
11352@samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
11353(for example, @samp{9600}).
11354
11355@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
11356If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
11357specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
11358@end table
11359
11360@node Hitachi Special
11361@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
11362
11363Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
11364
11365@table @code
11366
11367@kindex set machine
11368@kindex show machine
11369@item set machine h8300
11370@itemx set machine h8300h
11371Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
11372architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
11373to check which variant is currently in effect.
104c1213
JM
11374
11375@end table
11376
8e04817f
AC
11377@node H8/500
11378@subsection H8/500
104c1213
JM
11379
11380@table @code
11381
8e04817f
AC
11382@kindex set memory @var{mod}
11383@cindex memory models, H8/500
11384@item set memory @var{mod}
11385@itemx show memory
11386Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
11387@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
11388memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
11389@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
104c1213 11390
8e04817f 11391@end table
104c1213 11392
8e04817f
AC
11393@node i960
11394@subsection Intel i960
104c1213 11395
8e04817f 11396@table @code
104c1213 11397
8e04817f
AC
11398@kindex target mon960
11399@item target mon960 @var{dev}
11400MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
104c1213 11401
8e04817f
AC
11402@kindex target nindy
11403@item target nindy @var{devicename}
11404An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
11405the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
11406@file{/dev/ttya}.
104c1213 11407
8e04817f
AC
11408@end table
11409
11410@cindex Nindy
11411@cindex i960
11412@dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
11413@value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
11414tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
11415
11416@itemize @bullet
104c1213 11417@item
8e04817f
AC
11418Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
11419Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
104c1213
JM
11420
11421@item
8e04817f 11422By responding to a prompt on startup;
104c1213
JM
11423
11424@item
8e04817f
AC
11425By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
11426session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
11427
11428@end itemize
11429
11430@cindex download to Nindy-960
11431With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
11432downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
11433@value{GDBN}.
11434
11435@menu
11436* Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
11437* Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
11438* Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
11439@end menu
11440
11441@node Nindy Startup
11442@subsubsection Startup with Nindy
11443
11444If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
11445options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
11446reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
11447
474c8240 11448@smallexample
8e04817f 11449Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
474c8240 11450@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11451
11452@noindent
11453Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
11454identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
11455simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
11456with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
11457use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
11458
11459@node Nindy Options
11460@subsubsection Options for Nindy
11461
11462These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
11463Nindy-960 board attached:
11464
11465@table @code
11466@item -r @var{port}
11467Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
11468to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
11469configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
11470@var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
11471device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
11472suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
11473
11474@item -O
11475(An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
11476the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
11477This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
11478target architecture.
11479
11480@quotation
11481@emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
11482connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
11483fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
11484attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
11485this process with an interrupt.
11486@end quotation
11487
11488@item -brk
11489Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
11490system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
11491
11492@quotation
11493@emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
11494requires; it only works with a few boards.
11495@end quotation
11496@end table
11497
11498The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
11499port.
11500
11501@c @group
11502@node Nindy Reset
11503@subsubsection Nindy reset command
11504
11505@table @code
11506@item reset
11507@kindex reset
11508For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
11509system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
11510circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
11511a break is detected.
11512@end table
11513@c @end group
11514
11515@node M32R/D
11516@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
11517
11518@table @code
11519
11520@kindex target m32r
11521@item target m32r @var{dev}
11522Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
11523
11524@end table
11525
11526@node M68K
11527@subsection M68k
11528
11529The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
11530target command for the following ROM monitors.
11531
11532@table @code
11533
11534@kindex target abug
11535@item target abug @var{dev}
11536ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
11537
11538@kindex target cpu32bug
11539@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
11540CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11541
11542@kindex target dbug
11543@item target dbug @var{dev}
11544dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
11545
11546@kindex target est
11547@item target est @var{dev}
11548EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11549
11550@kindex target rom68k
11551@item target rom68k @var{dev}
11552ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
11553
11554@end table
11555
11556If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
11557instead have only a single special target command:
11558
11559@table @code
11560
11561@kindex target es1800
11562@item target es1800 @var{dev}
11563ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
11564
11565@end table
11566
11567[context?]
11568
11569@table @code
11570
11571@kindex target rombug
11572@item target rombug @var{dev}
11573ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
11574
11575@end table
11576
8e04817f
AC
11577@node MIPS Embedded
11578@subsection MIPS Embedded
11579
11580@cindex MIPS boards
11581@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
11582MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
11583you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
104c1213 11584
8e04817f
AC
11585@need 1000
11586Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
104c1213 11587
8e04817f
AC
11588@table @code
11589@item target mips @var{port}
11590@kindex target mips @var{port}
11591To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
11592name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
11593command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
11594the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
11595been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
11596download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
104c1213 11597
8e04817f
AC
11598For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
11599port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
11600debugger:
104c1213 11601
474c8240 11602@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11603host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
11604@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
11605(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
11606(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
11607(@value{GDBP}) run
474c8240 11608@end smallexample
104c1213 11609
8e04817f
AC
11610@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
11611On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
11612connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
11613concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
11614@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
104c1213 11615
8e04817f
AC
11616@item target pmon @var{port}
11617@kindex target pmon @var{port}
11618PMON ROM monitor.
104c1213 11619
8e04817f
AC
11620@item target ddb @var{port}
11621@kindex target ddb @var{port}
11622NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
104c1213 11623
8e04817f
AC
11624@item target lsi @var{port}
11625@kindex target lsi @var{port}
11626LSI variant of PMON.
104c1213 11627
8e04817f
AC
11628@kindex target r3900
11629@item target r3900 @var{dev}
11630Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
104c1213 11631
8e04817f
AC
11632@kindex target array
11633@item target array @var{dev}
11634Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
104c1213 11635
8e04817f 11636@end table
104c1213 11637
104c1213 11638
8e04817f
AC
11639@noindent
11640@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
104c1213 11641
8e04817f
AC
11642@table @code
11643@item set processor @var{args}
11644@itemx show processor
11645@kindex set processor @var{args}
11646@kindex show processor
11647Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
11648processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
11649For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
11650to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
11651Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
11652is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
11653@value{GDBN} is using.
104c1213 11654
8e04817f
AC
11655@item set mipsfpu double
11656@itemx set mipsfpu single
11657@itemx set mipsfpu none
11658@itemx show mipsfpu
11659@kindex set mipsfpu
11660@kindex show mipsfpu
11661@cindex MIPS remote floating point
11662@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
11663If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
11664coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
11665need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
11666file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
11667functions which return floating point values. It also allows
11668@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
11669functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
11670with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
11671processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
11672double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
11673@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
104c1213 11674
8e04817f
AC
11675In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
11676floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
11677and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
104c1213 11678
8e04817f
AC
11679As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
11680@samp{show mipsfpu}.
104c1213 11681
8e04817f
AC
11682@item set remotedebug @var{n}
11683@itemx show remotedebug
11684@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11685@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11686@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
11687@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
11688@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
11689@c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
11690You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
11691by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
11692@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
11693to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
11694at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
104c1213 11695
8e04817f
AC
11696@item set timeout @var{seconds}
11697@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
11698@itemx show timeout
11699@itemx show retransmit-timeout
11700@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
11701@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
11702@kindex set timeout
11703@kindex show timeout
11704@kindex set retransmit-timeout
11705@kindex show retransmit-timeout
11706You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
11707remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
11708default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
11709waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
11710retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
11711You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
11712retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
11713@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
104c1213 11714
8e04817f
AC
11715The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
11716is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
11717forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
11718to run before stopping.
11719@end table
104c1213 11720
a37295f9
MM
11721@node OpenRISC 1000
11722@subsection OpenRISC 1000
11723@cindex OpenRISC 1000
11724
11725@cindex or1k boards
11726See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
11727about platform and commands.
11728
11729@table @code
11730
11731@kindex target jtag
11732@item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
11733
11734Connects to remote JTAG server.
11735JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
11736connected via parallel port to the board.
11737
11738Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
11739
11740@kindex or1ksim
11741@item or1ksim @var{command}
11742If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
11743Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
11744
11745@kindex info or1k spr
11746@item info or1k spr
11747Displays spr groups.
11748
11749@item info or1k spr @var{group}
11750@itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
11751Displays register names in selected group.
11752
11753@item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
11754@itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
11755@itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
11756@itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
11757Shows information about specified spr register.
11758
11759@kindex spr
11760@item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
11761@itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
11762@itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
11763@itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
11764Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
11765@end table
11766
11767Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
11768It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
11769program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
11770triggers can be set using:
11771@table @code
11772@item $LEA/$LDATA
11773Load effective address/data
11774@item $SEA/$SDATA
11775Store effective address/data
11776@item $AEA/$ADATA
11777Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
11778@item $FETCH
11779Fetch data
11780@end table
11781
11782When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
11783@code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
11784
11785@code{htrace} commands:
11786@cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
11787@table @code
11788@kindex hwatch
11789@item hwatch @var{conditional}
11790Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effecive Address(es)
11791or Data. For example:
11792
11793@code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
11794
11795@code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
11796
11797@kindex htrace info
11798@item htrace info
11799Display information about current HW trace configuration.
11800
11801@kindex htrace trigger
11802@item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
11803Set starting criteria for HW trace.
11804
11805@kindex htrace qualifier
11806@item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
11807Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
11808
11809@kindex htrace stop
11810@item htrace stop @var{conditional}
11811Set HW trace stopping criteria.
11812
11813@kindex htrace record
11814@item htrace record @var{[data]*}
11815Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
11816triggered.
11817
11818@kindex htrace enable
11819@item htrace enable
11820@kindex htrace disable
11821@itemx htrace disable
11822Enables/disables the HW trace.
11823
11824@kindex htrace rewind
11825@item htrace rewind @var{[filename]}
11826Clears currently recorded trace data.
11827
11828If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
11829will be written there.
11830
11831@kindex htrace print
11832@item htrace print @var{[start [len]]}
11833Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
11834
11835@kindex htrace mode continuous
11836@item htrace mode continuous
11837Set continuous trace mode.
11838
11839@kindex htrace mode suspend
11840@item htrace mode suspend
11841Set suspend trace mode.
11842
11843@end table
11844
8e04817f
AC
11845@node PowerPC
11846@subsection PowerPC
104c1213
JM
11847
11848@table @code
104c1213 11849
8e04817f
AC
11850@kindex target dink32
11851@item target dink32 @var{dev}
11852DINK32 ROM monitor.
104c1213 11853
8e04817f
AC
11854@kindex target ppcbug
11855@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
11856@kindex target ppcbug1
11857@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
11858PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
104c1213 11859
8e04817f
AC
11860@kindex target sds
11861@item target sds @var{dev}
11862SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
11863
11864@end table
11865
11866@node PA
11867@subsection HP PA Embedded
104c1213
JM
11868
11869@table @code
11870
8e04817f
AC
11871@kindex target op50n
11872@item target op50n @var{dev}
11873OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
11874
11875@kindex target w89k
11876@item target w89k @var{dev}
11877W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
104c1213
JM
11878
11879@end table
11880
8e04817f
AC
11881@node SH
11882@subsection Hitachi SH
104c1213
JM
11883
11884@table @code
11885
8e04817f
AC
11886@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
11887@item target hms @var{dev}
11888A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
11889commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
11890the communications speed used.
104c1213 11891
8e04817f
AC
11892@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
11893@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11894E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
104c1213 11895
8e04817f
AC
11896@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
11897@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
11898@item target sh3 @var{dev}
11899@item target sh3e @var{dev}
11900Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
104c1213 11901
8e04817f 11902@end table
104c1213 11903
8e04817f
AC
11904@node Sparclet
11905@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
104c1213 11906
8e04817f
AC
11907@cindex Sparclet
11908
11909@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
11910Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
11911@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11912both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
11913@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
104c1213 11914
8e04817f
AC
11915@table @code
11916@item remotetimeout @var{args}
11917@kindex remotetimeout
11918@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
11919This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11920seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
104c1213
JM
11921@end table
11922
8e04817f
AC
11923@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
11924When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
11925information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
11926load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
11927@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
104c1213 11928
474c8240 11929@smallexample
8e04817f 11930sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
474c8240 11931@end smallexample
104c1213 11932
8e04817f 11933You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
104c1213 11934
474c8240 11935@smallexample
8e04817f 11936sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
474c8240 11937@end smallexample
104c1213 11938
8e04817f
AC
11939@cindex running, on Sparclet
11940Once you have set
11941your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11942run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
11943(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213 11944
8e04817f
AC
11945@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11946
474c8240 11947@smallexample
8e04817f 11948(gdbslet)
474c8240 11949@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
11950
11951@menu
8e04817f
AC
11952* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
11953* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
11954* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
11955* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
104c1213
JM
11956@end menu
11957
8e04817f
AC
11958@node Sparclet File
11959@subsubsection Setting file to debug
104c1213 11960
8e04817f 11961The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
104c1213 11962
474c8240 11963@smallexample
8e04817f 11964(gdbslet) file prog
474c8240 11965@end smallexample
104c1213 11966
8e04817f
AC
11967@need 1000
11968@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
11969@value{GDBN} locates
11970the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
11971path.
11972If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
11973files will be searched as well.
11974@value{GDBN} locates
11975the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
11976path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
11977If it fails
11978to find a file, it displays a message such as:
104c1213 11979
474c8240 11980@smallexample
8e04817f 11981prog: No such file or directory.
474c8240 11982@end smallexample
104c1213 11983
8e04817f
AC
11984When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
11985the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
11986@code{target} command again.
104c1213 11987
8e04817f
AC
11988@node Sparclet Connection
11989@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
104c1213 11990
8e04817f
AC
11991The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
11992To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
104c1213 11993
474c8240 11994@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11995(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
11996Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
11997main () at ../prog.c:3
474c8240 11998@end smallexample
104c1213 11999
8e04817f
AC
12000@need 750
12001@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
104c1213 12002
474c8240 12003@smallexample
8e04817f 12004Connected to ttya.
474c8240 12005@end smallexample
104c1213 12006
8e04817f
AC
12007@node Sparclet Download
12008@subsubsection Sparclet download
104c1213 12009
8e04817f
AC
12010@cindex download to Sparclet
12011Once connected to the Sparclet target,
12012you can use the @value{GDBN}
12013@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
12014The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
12015command.
12016Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
12017address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
12018offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
12019of each of the file's sections.
12020For instance, if the program
12021@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
12022and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
104c1213 12023
474c8240 12024@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12025(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
12026Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
474c8240 12027@end smallexample
104c1213 12028
8e04817f
AC
12029If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
12030to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
12031to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
12032
12033@node Sparclet Execution
12034@subsubsection Running and debugging
12035
12036@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
12037You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
12038commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
12039manual for the list of commands.
12040
474c8240 12041@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12042(gdbslet) b main
12043Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
12044(gdbslet) run
12045Starting program: prog
12046Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
120473 char *symarg = 0;
12048(gdbslet) step
120494 char *execarg = "hello!";
12050(gdbslet)
474c8240 12051@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12052
12053@node Sparclite
12054@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
104c1213
JM
12055
12056@table @code
12057
8e04817f
AC
12058@kindex target sparclite
12059@item target sparclite @var{dev}
12060Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
12061You must use an additional command to debug the program.
12062For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
12063remote protocol.
104c1213
JM
12064
12065@end table
12066
8e04817f
AC
12067@node ST2000
12068@subsection Tandem ST2000
104c1213 12069
8e04817f
AC
12070@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
12071STDBUG protocol.
104c1213 12072
8e04817f
AC
12073To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
12074manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
104c1213 12075
474c8240 12076@smallexample
8e04817f 12077target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
474c8240 12078@end smallexample
104c1213 12079
8e04817f
AC
12080@noindent
12081to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
12082the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
12083ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
12084connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
12085concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
104c1213 12086
8e04817f
AC
12087The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
12088this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
12089would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
12090(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
12091available on your host computer.
12092@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
12093@c basically hearsay.
104c1213 12094
8e04817f
AC
12095@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
12096These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
12097environment:
104c1213 12098
8e04817f
AC
12099@table @code
12100@item st2000 @var{command}
12101@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
12102@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
12103@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
12104Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
12105manual for available commands.
104c1213 12106
8e04817f
AC
12107@item connect
12108@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
12109Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
12110you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
12111sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
12112@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
12113@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
104c1213
JM
12114@end table
12115
8e04817f
AC
12116@node Z8000
12117@subsection Zilog Z8000
104c1213 12118
8e04817f
AC
12119@cindex Z8000
12120@cindex simulator, Z8000
12121@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
104c1213 12122
8e04817f
AC
12123When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
12124a Z8000 simulator.
12125
12126For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
12127unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
12128segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
12129appropriate by inspecting the object code.
104c1213 12130
8e04817f
AC
12131@table @code
12132@item target sim @var{args}
12133@kindex sim
12134@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
12135Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
12136options, specify them via @var{args}.
104c1213
JM
12137@end table
12138
8e04817f
AC
12139@noindent
12140After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
12141CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
12142@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
12143to run your program, and so on.
12144
12145As well as making available all the usual machine registers
12146(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
12147additional items of information as specially named registers:
104c1213
JM
12148
12149@table @code
12150
8e04817f
AC
12151@item cycles
12152Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
104c1213 12153
8e04817f
AC
12154@item insts
12155Counts instructions run in the simulator.
104c1213 12156
8e04817f
AC
12157@item time
12158Execution time in 60ths of a second.
104c1213 12159
8e04817f 12160@end table
104c1213 12161
8e04817f
AC
12162You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12163conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12164conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12165simulated clock ticks.
104c1213 12166
8e04817f
AC
12167@node Architectures
12168@section Architectures
104c1213 12169
8e04817f
AC
12170This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
12171all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
104c1213 12172
8e04817f
AC
12173@menu
12174* A29K::
12175* Alpha::
12176* MIPS::
12177@end menu
104c1213 12178
8e04817f
AC
12179@node A29K
12180@subsection A29K
104c1213
JM
12181
12182@table @code
104c1213 12183
8e04817f
AC
12184@kindex set rstack_high_address
12185@cindex AMD 29K register stack
12186@cindex register stack, AMD29K
12187@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12188On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
12189@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
12190extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12191stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12192memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
12193this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12194the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
12195address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12196hexadecimal.
104c1213 12197
8e04817f
AC
12198@kindex show rstack_high_address
12199@item show rstack_high_address
12200Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12201processors.
104c1213 12202
8e04817f 12203@end table
104c1213 12204
8e04817f
AC
12205@node Alpha
12206@subsection Alpha
104c1213 12207
8e04817f 12208See the following section.
104c1213 12209
8e04817f
AC
12210@node MIPS
12211@subsection MIPS
104c1213 12212
8e04817f
AC
12213@cindex stack on Alpha
12214@cindex stack on MIPS
12215@cindex Alpha stack
12216@cindex MIPS stack
12217Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12218sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12219find the beginning of a function.
104c1213 12220
8e04817f
AC
12221@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12222To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12223@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12224you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12225commands:
104c1213 12226
8e04817f
AC
12227@table @code
12228@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
12229@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12230Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12231search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12232default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12233larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12234and therefore the longer it takes to run.
104c1213 12235
8e04817f
AC
12236@item show heuristic-fence-post
12237Display the current limit.
12238@end table
104c1213
JM
12239
12240@noindent
8e04817f
AC
12241These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12242for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
104c1213 12243
104c1213 12244
8e04817f
AC
12245@node Controlling GDB
12246@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12247
12248You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12249@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
12250data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
12251described here.
12252
12253@menu
12254* Prompt:: Prompt
12255* Editing:: Command editing
12256* History:: Command history
12257* Screen Size:: Screen size
12258* Numbers:: Numbers
1e698235 12259* ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
8e04817f
AC
12260* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
12261* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
12262@end menu
12263
12264@node Prompt
12265@section Prompt
104c1213 12266
8e04817f 12267@cindex prompt
104c1213 12268
8e04817f
AC
12269@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
12270called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
12271can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
12272instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
12273the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
12274which one you are talking to.
104c1213 12275
8e04817f
AC
12276@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
12277prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
12278or a prompt that does not.
104c1213 12279
8e04817f
AC
12280@table @code
12281@kindex set prompt
12282@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
12283Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
104c1213 12284
8e04817f
AC
12285@kindex show prompt
12286@item show prompt
12287Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
104c1213
JM
12288@end table
12289
8e04817f
AC
12290@node Editing
12291@section Command editing
12292@cindex readline
12293@cindex command line editing
104c1213 12294
8e04817f
AC
12295@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
12296@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
12297command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
12298or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
12299substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
12300debugging sessions.
104c1213 12301
8e04817f
AC
12302You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
12303command @code{set}.
104c1213 12304
8e04817f
AC
12305@table @code
12306@kindex set editing
12307@cindex editing
12308@item set editing
12309@itemx set editing on
12310Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
104c1213 12311
8e04817f
AC
12312@item set editing off
12313Disable command line editing.
104c1213 12314
8e04817f
AC
12315@kindex show editing
12316@item show editing
12317Show whether command line editing is enabled.
104c1213
JM
12318@end table
12319
8e04817f
AC
12320@node History
12321@section Command history
12322
12323@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
12324debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
12325happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
12326history facility.
104c1213
JM
12327
12328@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12329@cindex history substitution
12330@cindex history file
12331@kindex set history filename
12332@kindex GDBHISTFILE
12333@item set history filename @var{fname}
12334Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
12335This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
12336list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
12337exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
12338the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
12339to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
12340@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
12341is not set.
104c1213 12342
8e04817f
AC
12343@cindex history save
12344@kindex set history save
12345@item set history save
12346@itemx set history save on
12347Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
12348@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
104c1213 12349
8e04817f
AC
12350@item set history save off
12351Stop recording command history in a file.
104c1213 12352
8e04817f
AC
12353@cindex history size
12354@kindex set history size
12355@item set history size @var{size}
12356Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
12357This defaults to the value of the environment variable
12358@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
104c1213
JM
12359@end table
12360
8e04817f
AC
12361@cindex history expansion
12362History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
12363@ifset have-readline-appendices
12364@xref{Event Designators}.
12365@end ifset
12366
12367Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
12368is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
12369@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
12370follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
12371a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
12372history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
12373@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
12374
12375The commands to control history expansion are:
104c1213
JM
12376
12377@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12378@kindex set history expansion
12379@item set history expansion on
12380@itemx set history expansion
12381Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
104c1213 12382
8e04817f
AC
12383@item set history expansion off
12384Disable history expansion.
104c1213 12385
8e04817f
AC
12386The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
12387editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
12388or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
12389@ifset have-readline-appendices
12390@xref{Command Line Editing}.
12391@end ifset
104c1213 12392
8e04817f
AC
12393@c @group
12394@kindex show history
12395@item show history
12396@itemx show history filename
12397@itemx show history save
12398@itemx show history size
12399@itemx show history expansion
12400These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
12401@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
12402@c @end group
12403@end table
12404
12405@table @code
12406@kindex shows
12407@item show commands
12408Display the last ten commands in the command history.
104c1213 12409
8e04817f
AC
12410@item show commands @var{n}
12411Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
12412
12413@item show commands +
12414Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
104c1213
JM
12415@end table
12416
8e04817f
AC
12417@node Screen Size
12418@section Screen size
12419@cindex size of screen
12420@cindex pauses in output
104c1213 12421
8e04817f
AC
12422Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
12423information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
12424@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
12425output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
12426to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
12427determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
12428printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
12429rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
12430
12431Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
12432driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
12433together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
12434@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
12435you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
12436width} commands:
12437
12438@table @code
12439@kindex set height
12440@kindex set width
12441@kindex show width
12442@kindex show height
12443@item set height @var{lpp}
12444@itemx show height
12445@itemx set width @var{cpl}
12446@itemx show width
12447These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
12448a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
12449commands display the current settings.
104c1213 12450
8e04817f
AC
12451If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
12452output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
12453file or to an editor buffer.
104c1213 12454
8e04817f
AC
12455Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
12456from wrapping its output.
104c1213
JM
12457@end table
12458
8e04817f
AC
12459@node Numbers
12460@section Numbers
12461@cindex number representation
12462@cindex entering numbers
104c1213 12463
8e04817f
AC
12464You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
12465@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
12466@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
12467begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
12468default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
12469numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
12470change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
12471radix} command.
104c1213 12472
8e04817f
AC
12473@table @code
12474@kindex set input-radix
12475@item set input-radix @var{base}
12476Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
12477for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12478specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
12479example, any of
104c1213 12480
8e04817f
AC
12481@smallexample
12482set radix 012
12483set radix 10.
12484set radix 0xa
12485@end smallexample
104c1213 12486
8e04817f
AC
12487@noindent
12488sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
12489leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
104c1213 12490
8e04817f
AC
12491@kindex set output-radix
12492@item set output-radix @var{base}
12493Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
12494for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12495specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
104c1213 12496
8e04817f
AC
12497@kindex show input-radix
12498@item show input-radix
12499Display the current default base for numeric input.
104c1213 12500
8e04817f
AC
12501@kindex show output-radix
12502@item show output-radix
12503Display the current default base for numeric display.
12504@end table
104c1213 12505
1e698235
DJ
12506@node ABI
12507@section Configuring the current ABI
12508
12509@value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
12510application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
12511conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
12512current ABI.
12513
12514@cindex float promotion
12515@kindex set coerce-float-to-double
12516
12517Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
12518function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
12519(i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
12520according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
12521(i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
12522@code{double} and then passed.
12523
12524Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
12525a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
12526as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
12527
12528@table @code
12529@item set coerce-float-to-double
12530@itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
12531Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
12532to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
12533
12534@item set coerce-float-to-double off
12535Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
12536functions.
12537@end table
12538
8e04817f
AC
12539@node Messages/Warnings
12540@section Optional warnings and messages
104c1213 12541
8e04817f
AC
12542By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
12543running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
12544command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
12545internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
104c1213 12546
8e04817f
AC
12547Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
12548which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
12549see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
104c1213 12550
8e04817f
AC
12551@table @code
12552@kindex set verbose
12553@item set verbose on
12554Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
104c1213 12555
8e04817f
AC
12556@item set verbose off
12557Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
104c1213 12558
8e04817f
AC
12559@kindex show verbose
12560@item show verbose
12561Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
12562@end table
104c1213 12563
8e04817f
AC
12564By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
12565object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
12566find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
12567symbol files}).
104c1213 12568
8e04817f 12569@table @code
104c1213 12570
8e04817f
AC
12571@kindex set complaints
12572@item set complaints @var{limit}
12573Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
12574unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
12575@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
12576to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
104c1213 12577
8e04817f
AC
12578@kindex show complaints
12579@item show complaints
12580Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
104c1213 12581
8e04817f 12582@end table
104c1213 12583
8e04817f
AC
12584By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
12585lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
12586you try to run a program which is already running:
104c1213 12587
474c8240 12588@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12589(@value{GDBP}) run
12590The program being debugged has been started already.
12591Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
474c8240 12592@end smallexample
104c1213 12593
8e04817f
AC
12594If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
12595commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
104c1213 12596
8e04817f 12597@table @code
104c1213 12598
8e04817f
AC
12599@kindex set confirm
12600@cindex flinching
12601@cindex confirmation
12602@cindex stupid questions
12603@item set confirm off
12604Disables confirmation requests.
104c1213 12605
8e04817f
AC
12606@item set confirm on
12607Enables confirmation requests (the default).
104c1213 12608
8e04817f
AC
12609@kindex show confirm
12610@item show confirm
12611Displays state of confirmation requests.
12612
12613@end table
104c1213 12614
8e04817f
AC
12615@node Debugging Output
12616@section Optional messages about internal happenings
104c1213 12617@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12618@kindex set debug arch
12619@item set debug arch
12620Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
12621@kindex show debug arch
12622@item show debug arch
12623Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
12624@kindex set debug event
12625@item set debug event
12626Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
12627default is off.
12628@kindex show debug event
12629@item show debug event
12630Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
12631info.
12632@kindex set debug expression
12633@item set debug expression
12634Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
12635default is off.
12636@kindex show debug expression
12637@item show debug expression
12638Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
12639debugging info.
12640@kindex set debug overload
12641@item set debug overload
12642Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
12643info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
12644is off.
12645@kindex show debug overload
12646@item show debug overload
12647Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
12648debugging info.
12649@kindex set debug remote
12650@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
12651@cindex serial connections, debugging
12652@item set debug remote
12653Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
12654the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
12655@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
12656@kindex show debug remote
12657@item show debug remote
12658Displays the state of display of remote packets.
12659@kindex set debug serial
12660@item set debug serial
12661Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
12662default is off.
12663@kindex show debug serial
12664@item show debug serial
12665Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
12666info.
12667@kindex set debug target
12668@item set debug target
12669Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
12670includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
12671default is off.
12672@kindex show debug target
12673@item show debug target
12674Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
12675info.
12676@kindex set debug varobj
12677@item set debug varobj
12678Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
12679info. The default is off.
12680@kindex show debug varobj
12681@item show debug varobj
12682Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
12683debugging info.
12684@end table
104c1213 12685
8e04817f
AC
12686@node Sequences
12687@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
104c1213 12688
8e04817f
AC
12689Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
12690command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
12691commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
12692files.
104c1213 12693
8e04817f
AC
12694@menu
12695* Define:: User-defined commands
12696* Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
12697* Command Files:: Command files
12698* Output:: Commands for controlled output
12699@end menu
104c1213 12700
8e04817f
AC
12701@node Define
12702@section User-defined commands
104c1213 12703
8e04817f
AC
12704@cindex user-defined command
12705A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
12706which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
12707@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
12708separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
12709via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
104c1213 12710
8e04817f
AC
12711@smallexample
12712define adder
12713 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
12714@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
12715
12716@noindent
8e04817f 12717To execute the command use:
104c1213 12718
8e04817f
AC
12719@smallexample
12720adder 1 2 3
12721@end smallexample
104c1213 12722
8e04817f
AC
12723@noindent
12724This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
12725its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
12726reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
12727functions calls.
104c1213
JM
12728
12729@table @code
104c1213 12730
8e04817f
AC
12731@kindex define
12732@item define @var{commandname}
12733Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
12734by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
104c1213 12735
8e04817f
AC
12736The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
12737which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
12738commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
104c1213 12739
8e04817f
AC
12740@kindex if
12741@kindex else
12742@item if
12743Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
12744It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
12745only if the expression is true (nonzero).
12746There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
12747by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
12748was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
104c1213 12749
8e04817f
AC
12750@kindex while
12751@item while
12752The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
12753which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
12754execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
12755The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
12756evaluates to true.
104c1213 12757
8e04817f
AC
12758@kindex document
12759@item document @var{commandname}
12760Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
12761accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
12762defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
12763reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
12764After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
12765@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
104c1213 12766
8e04817f
AC
12767You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
12768documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
12769does not change the documentation.
104c1213 12770
8e04817f
AC
12771@kindex help user-defined
12772@item help user-defined
12773List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
12774(if any) for each.
104c1213 12775
8e04817f
AC
12776@kindex show user
12777@item show user
12778@itemx show user @var{commandname}
12779Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
12780not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
12781definitions for all user-defined commands.
104c1213 12782
20f01a46
DH
12783@kindex show max-user-call-depth
12784@kindex set max-user-call-depth
12785@item show max-user-call-depth
5ca0cb28
DH
12786@itemx set max-user-call-depth
12787The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
12788levels are allowed in user-defined commands before GDB suspects an
12789infinite recursion and aborts the command.
20f01a46 12790
104c1213
JM
12791@end table
12792
8e04817f
AC
12793When user-defined commands are executed, the
12794commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
12795stops execution of the user-defined command.
104c1213 12796
8e04817f
AC
12797If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
12798without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
12799commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
12800messages when used in a user-defined command.
104c1213 12801
8e04817f
AC
12802@node Hooks
12803@section User-defined command hooks
12804@cindex command hooks
12805@cindex hooks, for commands
12806@cindex hooks, pre-command
104c1213 12807
8e04817f
AC
12808@kindex hook
12809@kindex hook-
12810You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
12811command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
12812command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
12813before that command.
104c1213 12814
8e04817f
AC
12815@cindex hooks, post-command
12816@kindex hookpost
12817@kindex hookpost-
12818A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
12819Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
12820@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
12821that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
12822pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
104c1213 12823
8e04817f
AC
12824It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
12825occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
104c1213 12826
8e04817f
AC
12827@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
12828@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
104c1213 12829
8e04817f
AC
12830@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
12831In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
12832(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
12833execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
12834displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
104c1213 12835
8e04817f
AC
12836For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
12837single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
12838you could define:
104c1213 12839
474c8240 12840@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12841define hook-stop
12842handle SIGALRM nopass
12843end
104c1213 12844
8e04817f
AC
12845define hook-run
12846handle SIGALRM pass
12847end
104c1213 12848
8e04817f
AC
12849define hook-continue
12850handle SIGLARM pass
12851end
474c8240 12852@end smallexample
104c1213 12853
8e04817f
AC
12854As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
12855command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
12856you could define:
104c1213 12857
474c8240 12858@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12859define hook-echo
12860echo <<<---
12861end
104c1213 12862
8e04817f
AC
12863define hookpost-echo
12864echo --->>>\n
12865end
104c1213 12866
8e04817f
AC
12867(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
12868<<<---Hello World--->>>
12869(@value{GDBP})
104c1213 12870
474c8240 12871@end smallexample
104c1213 12872
8e04817f
AC
12873You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
12874not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
12875name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
12876@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
12877@c or not?
12878If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
12879@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
12880(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
104c1213 12881
8e04817f
AC
12882If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
12883get a warning from the @code{define} command.
c906108c 12884
8e04817f
AC
12885@node Command Files
12886@section Command files
c906108c 12887
8e04817f
AC
12888@cindex command files
12889A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
12890commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
12891An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
12892the last command, as it would from the terminal.
c906108c 12893
8e04817f
AC
12894@cindex init file
12895@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
12896@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
12897When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
12898@dfn{init files}, normally called @file{.gdbinit}@footnote{The DJGPP
12899port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini} instead, due to the
12900limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems.}.
12901During startup, @value{GDBN} does the following:
c906108c 12902
8e04817f
AC
12903@enumerate
12904@item
12905Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
12906DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
12907@code{HOME} environment variable.}.
c906108c 12908
8e04817f
AC
12909@item
12910Processes command line options and operands.
c906108c 12911
8e04817f
AC
12912@item
12913Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
c906108c 12914
8e04817f
AC
12915@item
12916Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
12917@end enumerate
c906108c 12918
8e04817f
AC
12919The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
12920complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
12921and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
12922option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
c906108c 12923
8e04817f
AC
12924@cindex init file name
12925On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
12926different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
12927form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
12928different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
12929environments with special init file names:
c906108c 12930
8e04817f
AC
12931@cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
12932@itemize @bullet
12933@item
12934VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c 12935
8e04817f
AC
12936@cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
12937@item
12938OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 12939
8e04817f
AC
12940@cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
12941@item
12942ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
12943@end itemize
c906108c 12944
8e04817f
AC
12945You can also request the execution of a command file with the
12946@code{source} command:
c906108c 12947
8e04817f
AC
12948@table @code
12949@kindex source
12950@item source @var{filename}
12951Execute the command file @var{filename}.
c906108c
SS
12952@end table
12953
8e04817f 12954The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
a71ec265
DH
12955printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
12956execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
c906108c 12957
8e04817f
AC
12958Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
12959without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
12960normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
12961when called from command files.
c906108c 12962
8e04817f
AC
12963@value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
12964mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
12965standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
12966not terminate execution of the command file --- execution continues with
12967the next command.
c906108c 12968
474c8240 12969@smallexample
8e04817f 12970gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
474c8240 12971@end smallexample
c906108c 12972
8e04817f
AC
12973(The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
12974will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
12975would be directed to @file{log}.
c906108c 12976
8e04817f
AC
12977@node Output
12978@section Commands for controlled output
c906108c 12979
8e04817f
AC
12980During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
12981@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
12982explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
12983describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
12984want.
c906108c
SS
12985
12986@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12987@kindex echo
12988@item echo @var{text}
12989@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
12990@c because it is not in ANSI.
12991Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
12992@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
12993newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
12994In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
12995by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
12996string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
12997trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
12998To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
12999@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
c906108c 13000
8e04817f
AC
13001A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
13002the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
c906108c 13003
474c8240 13004@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13005echo This is some text\n\
13006which is continued\n\
13007onto several lines.\n
474c8240 13008@end smallexample
c906108c 13009
8e04817f 13010produces the same output as
c906108c 13011
474c8240 13012@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13013echo This is some text\n
13014echo which is continued\n
13015echo onto several lines.\n
474c8240 13016@end smallexample
c906108c 13017
8e04817f
AC
13018@kindex output
13019@item output @var{expression}
13020Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
13021newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
13022value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
13023on expressions.
c906108c 13024
8e04817f
AC
13025@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
13026Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
13027the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
13028formats}, for more information.
c906108c 13029
8e04817f
AC
13030@kindex printf
13031@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
13032Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
13033@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
13034either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
13035@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
13036subroutine
13037@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
13038@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
13039@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
13040@c supported.
c906108c 13041
474c8240 13042@smallexample
8e04817f 13043printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
474c8240 13044@end smallexample
c906108c 13045
8e04817f 13046For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
c906108c 13047
8e04817f
AC
13048@smallexample
13049printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
13050@end smallexample
c906108c 13051
8e04817f
AC
13052The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
13053string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
13054letter.
c906108c
SS
13055@end table
13056
8e04817f
AC
13057@node TUI
13058@chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
13059@cindex TUI
c906108c 13060
8e04817f
AC
13061@menu
13062* TUI Overview:: TUI overview
13063* TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
7cf36c78 13064* TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
8e04817f
AC
13065* TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
13066* TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
13067@end menu
c906108c 13068
8e04817f
AC
13069The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short,
13070is a terminal interface which uses the @code{curses} library
13071to show the source file, the assembly output, the program registers
13072and @value{GDBN} commands in separate text windows.
13073The TUI is available only when @value{GDBN} is configured
13074with the @code{--enable-tui} configure option (@pxref{Configure Options}).
c906108c 13075
8e04817f
AC
13076@node TUI Overview
13077@section TUI overview
c906108c 13078
8e04817f
AC
13079The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
13080@value{GDBN} runs:
c906108c 13081
8e04817f
AC
13082@itemize @bullet
13083@item
13084A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
13085windows on the terminal.
c906108c 13086
8e04817f
AC
13087@item
13088A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
13089the TUI.
13090@end itemize
c906108c 13091
8e04817f
AC
13092In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
13093on the terminal:
c906108c 13094
8e04817f
AC
13095@table @emph
13096@item command
13097This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
13098prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
13099managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
13100window is always visible.
c906108c 13101
8e04817f
AC
13102@item source
13103The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
13104line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
c906108c 13105
8e04817f
AC
13106@item assembly
13107The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
c906108c 13108
8e04817f
AC
13109@item register
13110This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
13111a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
13112changed are highlighted.
c906108c 13113
c906108c
SS
13114@end table
13115
269c21fe
SC
13116The source and assembly windows show the current program position
13117by highlighting the current line and marking them with the @samp{>} marker.
13118Breakpoints are also indicated with two markers. A first one
13119indicates the breakpoint type:
13120
13121@table @code
13122@item B
13123Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13124
13125@item b
13126Breakpoint which was never hit.
13127
13128@item H
13129Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13130
13131@item h
13132Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
13133
13134@end table
13135
13136The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
13137
13138@table @code
13139@item +
13140Breakpoint is enabled.
13141
13142@item -
13143Breakpoint is disabled.
13144
13145@end table
13146
8e04817f
AC
13147The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
13148and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
13149changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
13150These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
13151layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
13152The following layouts are available:
c906108c 13153
8e04817f
AC
13154@itemize @bullet
13155@item
13156source
2df3850c 13157
8e04817f
AC
13158@item
13159assembly
13160
13161@item
13162source and assembly
13163
13164@item
13165source and registers
c906108c 13166
8e04817f
AC
13167@item
13168assembly and registers
2df3850c 13169
8e04817f 13170@end itemize
c906108c 13171
b7bb15bc
SC
13172On top of the command window a status line gives various information
13173concerning the current process begin debugged. The status line is
13174updated when the information it shows changes. The following fields
13175are displayed:
13176
13177@table @emph
13178@item target
13179Indicates the current gdb target
13180(@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13181
13182@item process
13183Gives information about the current process or thread number.
13184When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
13185
13186@item function
13187Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
13188The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
13189When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter
13190the string @code{??} is displayed.
13191
13192@item line
13193Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
13194When the current line number is not known the string @code{??} is displayed.
13195
13196@item pc
13197Indicates the current program counter address.
13198
13199@end table
13200
8e04817f
AC
13201@node TUI Keys
13202@section TUI Key Bindings
13203@cindex TUI key bindings
c906108c 13204
8e04817f
AC
13205The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
13206(@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
13207They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
7cf36c78
SC
13208directly on the TUI layout and windows. The TUI also provides
13209a @emph{SingleKey} keymap which binds several keys directly to
13210@value{GDBN} commands. The following key bindings
8e04817f 13211are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
c906108c 13212
8e04817f
AC
13213@table @kbd
13214@kindex C-x C-a
13215@item C-x C-a
13216@kindex C-x a
13217@itemx C-x a
13218@kindex C-x A
13219@itemx C-x A
13220Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
13221the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
13222its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
13223mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
13224The screen is then refreshed.
c906108c 13225
8e04817f
AC
13226@kindex C-x 1
13227@item C-x 1
13228Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
13229either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
13230is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
2df3850c 13231
8e04817f 13232Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
c906108c 13233
8e04817f
AC
13234@kindex C-x 2
13235@item C-x 2
13236Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
13237layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
13238When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
13239previous layout and the new one.
c906108c 13240
8e04817f 13241Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
2df3850c 13242
7cf36c78
SC
13243@kindex C-x s
13244@item C-x s
13245Use the TUI @emph{SingleKey} keymap that binds single key to gdb commands
13246(@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
13247
c906108c
SS
13248@end table
13249
8e04817f 13250The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
5d161b24 13251
8e04817f
AC
13252@table @key
13253@kindex PgUp
13254@item PgUp
13255Scroll the active window one page up.
c906108c 13256
8e04817f
AC
13257@kindex PgDn
13258@item PgDn
13259Scroll the active window one page down.
c906108c 13260
8e04817f
AC
13261@kindex Up
13262@item Up
13263Scroll the active window one line up.
c906108c 13264
8e04817f
AC
13265@kindex Down
13266@item Down
13267Scroll the active window one line down.
c906108c 13268
8e04817f
AC
13269@kindex Left
13270@item Left
13271Scroll the active window one column left.
c906108c 13272
8e04817f
AC
13273@kindex Right
13274@item Right
13275Scroll the active window one column right.
c906108c 13276
8e04817f
AC
13277@kindex C-L
13278@item C-L
13279Refresh the screen.
c906108c 13280
8e04817f 13281@end table
c906108c 13282
8e04817f
AC
13283In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
13284for scrolling. This means they are not available for readline. It is
13285necessary to use other readline key bindings such as @key{C-p}, @key{C-n},
13286@key{C-b} and @key{C-f}.
13287
7cf36c78
SC
13288@node TUI Single Key Mode
13289@section TUI Single Key Mode
13290@cindex TUI single key mode
13291
13292The TUI provides a @emph{SingleKey} mode in which it installs a particular
13293key binding in the readline keymaps to connect single keys to
13294some gdb commands.
13295
13296@table @kbd
13297@kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13298@item c
13299continue
13300
13301@kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13302@item d
13303down
13304
13305@kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13306@item f
13307finish
13308
13309@kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13310@item n
13311next
13312
13313@kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13314@item q
13315exit the @emph{SingleKey} mode.
13316
13317@kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13318@item r
13319run
13320
13321@kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13322@item s
13323step
13324
13325@kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13326@item u
13327up
13328
13329@kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13330@item v
13331info locals
13332
13333@kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13334@item w
13335where
13336
13337@end table
13338
13339Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
13340The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
13341it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
13342with the TUI @emph{SingleKey} mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
13343@emph{SingleKey} mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
13344this mode is by hitting @key{q} or @samp{@key{C-x} @key{s}}.
13345
13346
8e04817f
AC
13347@node TUI Commands
13348@section TUI specific commands
13349@cindex TUI commands
13350
13351The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
13352These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
13353the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
13354is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
13355in the TUI mode.
c906108c
SS
13356
13357@table @code
3d757584
SC
13358@item info win
13359@kindex info win
13360List and give the size of all displayed windows.
13361
8e04817f
AC
13362@item layout next
13363@kindex layout next
13364Display the next layout.
2df3850c 13365
8e04817f
AC
13366@item layout prev
13367@kindex layout prev
13368Display the previous layout.
c906108c 13369
8e04817f
AC
13370@item layout src
13371@kindex layout src
13372Display the source window only.
c906108c 13373
8e04817f
AC
13374@item layout asm
13375@kindex layout asm
13376Display the assembly window only.
c906108c 13377
8e04817f
AC
13378@item layout split
13379@kindex layout split
13380Display the source and assembly window.
c906108c 13381
8e04817f
AC
13382@item layout regs
13383@kindex layout regs
13384Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
13385
13386@item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
13387@kindex focus
13388Set the focus to the named window.
13389This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
13390can be affected to another window.
c906108c 13391
8e04817f
AC
13392@item refresh
13393@kindex refresh
13394Refresh the screen. This is similar to using @key{C-L} key.
c906108c 13395
8e04817f
AC
13396@item update
13397@kindex update
13398Update the source window and the current execution point.
c906108c 13399
8e04817f
AC
13400@item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
13401@itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
13402@kindex winheight
13403Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
13404lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
13405decrease it.
2df3850c 13406
c906108c
SS
13407@end table
13408
8e04817f
AC
13409@node TUI Configuration
13410@section TUI configuration variables
13411@cindex TUI configuration variables
c906108c 13412
8e04817f
AC
13413The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
13414appearance of windows on the terminal.
c906108c 13415
8e04817f
AC
13416@table @code
13417@item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
13418@kindex set tui border-kind
13419Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
13420The possible values are the following:
13421@table @code
13422@item space
13423Use a space character to draw the border.
c906108c 13424
8e04817f
AC
13425@item ascii
13426Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
c906108c 13427
8e04817f
AC
13428@item acs
13429Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
13430drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
c78b4128 13431
8e04817f 13432@end table
c78b4128 13433
8e04817f
AC
13434@item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
13435@kindex set tui active-border-mode
13436Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
13437The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
13438@code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
c78b4128 13439
8e04817f
AC
13440@item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
13441@kindex set tui border-mode
13442Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
13443The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
13444@table @code
13445@item normal
13446Use normal attributes to display the border.
c906108c 13447
8e04817f
AC
13448@item standout
13449Use standout mode.
c906108c 13450
8e04817f
AC
13451@item reverse
13452Use reverse video mode.
c906108c 13453
8e04817f
AC
13454@item half
13455Use half bright mode.
c906108c 13456
8e04817f
AC
13457@item half-standout
13458Use half bright and standout mode.
c906108c 13459
8e04817f
AC
13460@item bold
13461Use extra bright or bold mode.
c78b4128 13462
8e04817f
AC
13463@item bold-standout
13464Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
c78b4128 13465
8e04817f 13466@end table
c78b4128 13467
8e04817f 13468@end table
c78b4128 13469
8e04817f
AC
13470@node Emacs
13471@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
c78b4128 13472
8e04817f
AC
13473@cindex Emacs
13474@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
13475A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
13476edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
13477@value{GDBN}.
c906108c 13478
8e04817f
AC
13479To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
13480executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
13481@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
13482created Emacs buffer.
13483@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
c906108c 13484
8e04817f
AC
13485Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
13486things:
c906108c 13487
8e04817f
AC
13488@itemize @bullet
13489@item
13490All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
13491@end itemize
c906108c 13492
8e04817f
AC
13493This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
13494and output done by the program you are debugging.
bf0184be 13495
8e04817f
AC
13496This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
13497commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
13498in this way.
bf0184be 13499
8e04817f
AC
13500All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
13501with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
13502way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
13503stop.
bf0184be 13504
8e04817f 13505@itemize @bullet
bf0184be 13506@item
8e04817f
AC
13507@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
13508@end itemize
bf0184be 13509
8e04817f
AC
13510Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
13511source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
13512left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
13513source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
13514and the source.
bf0184be 13515
8e04817f
AC
13516Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
13517usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
c906108c 13518
8e04817f
AC
13519@quotation
13520@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
13521current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
13522the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
13523appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
13524environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
13525session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
13526back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
13527avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
13528your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
13529@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
c906108c 13530
8e04817f
AC
13531A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
13532switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
13533@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
13534@end quotation
13535
13536By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
13537you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
13538several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
13539Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
13540
474c8240 13541@smallexample
8e04817f 13542(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
474c8240 13543@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13544
13545@noindent
13546(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
13547in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
13548``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
13549
13550In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
13551addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
c906108c 13552
8e04817f
AC
13553@table @kbd
13554@item C-h m
13555Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
c906108c 13556
8e04817f
AC
13557@item M-s
13558Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
13559update the display window to show the current file and location.
c906108c 13560
8e04817f
AC
13561@item M-n
13562Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
13563calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
13564to show the current file and location.
c906108c 13565
8e04817f
AC
13566@item M-i
13567Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
13568display window accordingly.
c906108c 13569
8e04817f
AC
13570@item M-x gdb-nexti
13571Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
13572display window accordingly.
c906108c 13573
8e04817f
AC
13574@item C-c C-f
13575Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
13576@code{finish} command.
c906108c 13577
8e04817f
AC
13578@item M-c
13579Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
13580command.
b433d00b 13581
8e04817f 13582@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
b433d00b 13583
8e04817f
AC
13584@item M-u
13585Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
13586(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
13587like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
b433d00b 13588
8e04817f 13589@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
c906108c 13590
8e04817f
AC
13591@item M-d
13592Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
13593@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
c906108c 13594
8e04817f 13595@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
c906108c 13596
8e04817f
AC
13597@item C-x &
13598Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
13599of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
13600around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
13601then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
13602argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
c906108c 13603
8e04817f
AC
13604You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
13605@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
13606otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
13607inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
13608wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
13609list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
13610formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
13611is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
13612@end table
c906108c 13613
8e04817f
AC
13614In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
13615tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
c906108c 13616
8e04817f
AC
13617If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
13618it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
13619request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
13620the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
13621frame.
c906108c 13622
8e04817f
AC
13623The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
13624which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
13625the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
13626communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
13627delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
13628to correspond properly with the code.
c906108c 13629
8e04817f
AC
13630@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
13631@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
13632@ignore
13633@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
13634@kindex Epoch
13635@kindex inspect
c906108c 13636
8e04817f
AC
13637Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
13638called the @code{epoch}
13639environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
13640@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
13641each value is printed in its own window.
13642@end ignore
c906108c 13643
8e04817f
AC
13644@include annotate.texi
13645@include gdbmi.texinfo
c906108c 13646
8e04817f
AC
13647@node GDB Bugs
13648@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
13649@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
13650@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
c906108c 13651
8e04817f 13652Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
c906108c 13653
8e04817f
AC
13654Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
13655may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
13656the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
13657reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
c906108c 13658
8e04817f
AC
13659In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
13660information that enables us to fix the bug.
c4555f82
SC
13661
13662@menu
8e04817f
AC
13663* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
13664* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
c4555f82
SC
13665@end menu
13666
8e04817f
AC
13667@node Bug Criteria
13668@section Have you found a bug?
13669@cindex bug criteria
c4555f82 13670
8e04817f 13671If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
c4555f82
SC
13672
13673@itemize @bullet
8e04817f
AC
13674@cindex fatal signal
13675@cindex debugger crash
13676@cindex crash of debugger
c4555f82 13677@item
8e04817f
AC
13678If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
13679@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
13680
13681@cindex error on valid input
13682@item
13683If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
13684bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
13685somewhere in the connection to the target.)
c4555f82 13686
8e04817f 13687@cindex invalid input
c4555f82 13688@item
8e04817f
AC
13689If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
13690that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
13691``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
13692for traditional practice''.
13693
13694@item
13695If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
13696for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
c4555f82
SC
13697@end itemize
13698
8e04817f
AC
13699@node Bug Reporting
13700@section How to report bugs
13701@cindex bug reports
13702@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
13703
13704A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
13705If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
13706contact that organization first.
13707
13708You can find contact information for many support companies and
13709individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
13710distribution.
13711@c should add a web page ref...
13712
129188f6
AC
13713In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
13714@value{GDBN}. The prefered method is to submit them directly using
13715@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
13716page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
13717be used.
8e04817f
AC
13718
13719@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
13720@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
13721not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
13722@samp{bug-gdb}.
13723
13724The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
13725serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
13726the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
13727newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
13728problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
13729path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
13730we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
13731bug reports to the mailing list.
c4555f82 13732
8e04817f
AC
13733The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
13734@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
13735fact or leave it out, state it!
c4555f82 13736
8e04817f
AC
13737Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
13738problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
13739assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
13740Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
13741stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
13742name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
13743of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
13744the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
13745easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
c4555f82 13746
8e04817f
AC
13747Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
13748bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
13749you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
13750self-contained.
c4555f82 13751
8e04817f
AC
13752Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
13753bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
13754@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
13755bugs properly.
13756
13757To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
c4555f82
SC
13758
13759@itemize @bullet
13760@item
8e04817f
AC
13761The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
13762with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
13763version}.
c4555f82 13764
8e04817f
AC
13765Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
13766the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
c4555f82
SC
13767
13768@item
8e04817f
AC
13769The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
13770version number.
c4555f82
SC
13771
13772@item
8e04817f
AC
13773What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
13774``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
c4555f82
SC
13775
13776@item
8e04817f
AC
13777What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
13778debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
13779C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
13780information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
13781compilers.
c4555f82 13782
8e04817f
AC
13783@item
13784The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
13785observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
13786you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
13787Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
c4555f82 13788
8e04817f
AC
13789If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
13790and then we might not encounter the bug.
c4555f82 13791
8e04817f
AC
13792@item
13793A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
13794reproduce the bug.
c4555f82 13795
8e04817f
AC
13796@item
13797A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
13798incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
c4555f82 13799
8e04817f
AC
13800Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
13801will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
13802not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
13803a chance to make a mistake.
c4555f82 13804
8e04817f
AC
13805Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
13806say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
13807copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
13808the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
13809crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
13810ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
13811us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
13812to draw any conclusion from our observations.
c4555f82 13813
8e04817f
AC
13814@item
13815If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
13816diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
13817it by context, not by line number.
c4555f82 13818
8e04817f
AC
13819The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
13820sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
c4555f82 13821
8e04817f 13822@end itemize
c4555f82 13823
8e04817f 13824Here are some things that are not necessary:
c4555f82 13825
8e04817f
AC
13826@itemize @bullet
13827@item
13828A description of the envelope of the bug.
c4555f82 13829
8e04817f
AC
13830Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
13831which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
13832changes will not affect it.
c4555f82 13833
8e04817f
AC
13834This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
13835will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
13836with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
13837We recommend that you save your time for something else.
c4555f82 13838
8e04817f
AC
13839Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
13840of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
13841output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
13842less time, and so on.
c4555f82 13843
8e04817f
AC
13844However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
13845report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
c4555f82 13846
8e04817f
AC
13847@item
13848A patch for the bug.
c4555f82 13849
8e04817f
AC
13850A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
13851the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
13852a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
13853to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
c4555f82 13854
8e04817f
AC
13855Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
13856construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
13857through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
13858to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
c4555f82 13859
8e04817f
AC
13860And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
13861patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
13862help us to understand.
c4555f82 13863
8e04817f
AC
13864@item
13865A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
c4555f82 13866
8e04817f
AC
13867Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
13868things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
13869@end itemize
c4555f82 13870
8e04817f
AC
13871@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
13872@c and consists of the two following files:
13873@c rluser.texinfo
13874@c inc-hist.texinfo
13875@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
13876@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
13877@include rluser.texinfo
13878@include inc-hist.texinfo
c4555f82 13879
c4555f82 13880
8e04817f
AC
13881@node Formatting Documentation
13882@appendix Formatting Documentation
c4555f82 13883
8e04817f
AC
13884@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
13885@cindex reference card
13886The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
13887for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
13888subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
13889@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
13890release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
13891you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
c4555f82 13892
8e04817f
AC
13893The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
13894can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
c4555f82 13895
474c8240 13896@smallexample
8e04817f 13897make refcard.dvi
474c8240 13898@end smallexample
c4555f82 13899
8e04817f
AC
13900The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
13901mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
13902that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
13903high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
13904your @sc{dvi} output program.
c4555f82 13905
8e04817f 13906@cindex documentation
c4555f82 13907
8e04817f
AC
13908All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
13909distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
13910a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
13911on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
13912formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
13913and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
c4555f82 13914
8e04817f
AC
13915@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
13916version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
13917file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
13918subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
13919necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
13920but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
13921Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
13922@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
c4555f82 13923
8e04817f
AC
13924If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
13925Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
13926@code{makeinfo}.
c4555f82 13927
8e04817f
AC
13928If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
13929@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
13930version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
c4555f82 13931
474c8240 13932@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13933cd gdb
13934make gdb.info
474c8240 13935@end smallexample
c4555f82 13936
8e04817f
AC
13937If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
13938a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
13939Texinfo definitions file.
c4555f82 13940
8e04817f
AC
13941@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
13942produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
13943document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
13944has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
13945command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
13946(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
13947require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
c4555f82 13948
8e04817f
AC
13949@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
13950@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
13951written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
13952typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
13953and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
13954directory.
c4555f82 13955
8e04817f
AC
13956If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
13957typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
13958subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
13959@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
c4555f82 13960
474c8240 13961@smallexample
8e04817f 13962make gdb.dvi
474c8240 13963@end smallexample
c4555f82 13964
8e04817f 13965Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
c4555f82 13966
8e04817f
AC
13967@node Installing GDB
13968@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
13969@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
13970@cindex installation
c4555f82 13971
8e04817f
AC
13972@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
13973of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
13974build the @code{gdb} program.
13975@iftex
13976@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
13977@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
13978look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
13979installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
13980@end iftex
c4555f82 13981
8e04817f
AC
13982The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
13983@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
13984appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
c4555f82 13985
8e04817f
AC
13986For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
13987@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
c4555f82 13988
8e04817f
AC
13989@table @code
13990@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
13991script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
c4555f82 13992
8e04817f
AC
13993@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
13994the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
c4555f82 13995
8e04817f
AC
13996@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
13997source for the Binary File Descriptor library
c906108c 13998
8e04817f
AC
13999@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
14000@sc{gnu} include files
c906108c 14001
8e04817f
AC
14002@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
14003source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
c906108c 14004
8e04817f
AC
14005@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
14006source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
c906108c 14007
8e04817f
AC
14008@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
14009source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
c906108c 14010
8e04817f
AC
14011@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
14012source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
c906108c 14013
8e04817f
AC
14014@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
14015source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
14016@end table
c906108c 14017
8e04817f
AC
14018The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
14019from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
14020this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
c906108c 14021
8e04817f
AC
14022First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
14023if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
14024identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
14025argument.
c906108c 14026
8e04817f 14027For example:
c906108c 14028
474c8240 14029@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14030cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
14031./configure @var{host}
14032make
474c8240 14033@end smallexample
c906108c 14034
8e04817f
AC
14035@noindent
14036where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
14037@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
14038(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
14039correct value by examining your system.)
c906108c 14040
8e04817f
AC
14041Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
14042@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
14043libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
14044binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
c906108c 14045
8e04817f
AC
14046@need 750
14047@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
14048system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
14049shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
c906108c 14050
474c8240 14051@smallexample
8e04817f 14052sh configure @var{host}
474c8240 14053@end smallexample
c906108c 14054
8e04817f
AC
14055If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
14056directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
14057@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
14058creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
14059you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
14060
14061You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
14062subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
14063configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
c906108c 14064
8e04817f
AC
14065For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
14066the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
c906108c 14067
474c8240 14068@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14069@group
14070cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
14071../configure @var{host}
14072@end group
474c8240 14073@end smallexample
c906108c 14074
8e04817f
AC
14075You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
14076However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
14077the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
14078that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
14079let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
c906108c 14080
8e04817f
AC
14081@menu
14082* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
14083* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
14084* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
14085@end menu
c906108c 14086
8e04817f
AC
14087@node Separate Objdir
14088@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
c906108c 14089
8e04817f
AC
14090If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
14091you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
14092host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
14093allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
14094rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
14095handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
14096@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
14097program specified there.
c906108c 14098
8e04817f
AC
14099To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
14100with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
14101(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
14102itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
14103would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
14104the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
c906108c 14105
8e04817f
AC
14106For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
14107separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
c906108c 14108
474c8240 14109@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14110@group
14111cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
14112mkdir ../gdb-sun4
14113cd ../gdb-sun4
14114../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
14115make
14116@end group
474c8240 14117@end smallexample
c906108c 14118
8e04817f
AC
14119When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
14120directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
14121(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
14122the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
14123directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
14124@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
c906108c 14125
8e04817f
AC
14126One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
14127directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
14128@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
14129programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
14130You specify a cross-debugging target by
14131giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
c906108c 14132
8e04817f
AC
14133When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
14134it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
14135called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
c906108c 14136
8e04817f
AC
14137The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
14138directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
14139directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
14140directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
14141will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
c906108c 14142
8e04817f
AC
14143When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
14144directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
14145if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
14146with each other.
c906108c 14147
8e04817f
AC
14148@node Config Names
14149@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
c906108c 14150
8e04817f
AC
14151The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
14152script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
14153aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
14154of information in the following pattern:
c906108c 14155
474c8240 14156@smallexample
8e04817f 14157@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
474c8240 14158@end smallexample
c906108c 14159
8e04817f
AC
14160For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
14161or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
14162option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
c906108c 14163
8e04817f
AC
14164The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
14165any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
14166aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
14167@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
14168script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
14169abbreviations---for example:
c906108c 14170
8e04817f
AC
14171@smallexample
14172% sh config.sub i386-linux
14173i386-pc-linux-gnu
14174% sh config.sub alpha-linux
14175alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
14176% sh config.sub hp9k700
14177hppa1.1-hp-hpux
14178% sh config.sub sun4
14179sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
14180% sh config.sub sun3
14181m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
14182% sh config.sub i986v
14183Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
14184@end smallexample
c906108c 14185
8e04817f
AC
14186@noindent
14187@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
14188directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
d700128c 14189
8e04817f
AC
14190@node Configure Options
14191@section @code{configure} options
c906108c 14192
8e04817f
AC
14193Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
14194are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
14195several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
14196Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
c906108c 14197
474c8240 14198@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14199configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
14200 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14201 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14202 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
14203 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
14204 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
14205 @var{host}
474c8240 14206@end smallexample
c906108c 14207
8e04817f
AC
14208@noindent
14209You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
14210@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
14211@samp{--}.
c906108c 14212
8e04817f
AC
14213@table @code
14214@item --help
14215Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
c906108c 14216
8e04817f
AC
14217@item --prefix=@var{dir}
14218Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
14219@file{@var{dir}}.
c906108c 14220
8e04817f
AC
14221@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
14222Configure the source to install programs under directory
14223@file{@var{dir}}.
c906108c 14224
8e04817f
AC
14225@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
14226@need 2000
14227@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
14228@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
14229@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
14230Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
14231@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
14232build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
14233directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
14234the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
14235directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
14236the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
14237@var{dirname}.
c906108c 14238
8e04817f
AC
14239@item --norecursion
14240Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
14241propagate configuration to subdirectories.
c906108c 14242
8e04817f
AC
14243@item --target=@var{target}
14244Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
14245@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
14246programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
c906108c 14247
8e04817f 14248There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
c906108c 14249
8e04817f
AC
14250@item @var{host} @dots{}
14251Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
c906108c 14252
8e04817f
AC
14253There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
14254@end table
c906108c 14255
8e04817f
AC
14256There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
14257needed for special purposes only.
c906108c 14258
8e04817f
AC
14259@node Maintenance Commands
14260@appendix Maintenance Commands
14261@cindex maintenance commands
14262@cindex internal commands
c906108c 14263
8e04817f
AC
14264In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
14265includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers.
14266These commands are provided here for reference.
c906108c 14267
8e04817f
AC
14268@table @code
14269@kindex maint info breakpoints
14270@item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
14271Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
14272breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
14273internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
14274breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
14275is shown:
c906108c 14276
8e04817f
AC
14277@table @code
14278@item breakpoint
14279Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
c906108c 14280
8e04817f
AC
14281@item watchpoint
14282Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
c906108c 14283
8e04817f
AC
14284@item longjmp
14285Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
14286@code{longjmp} calls.
c906108c 14287
8e04817f
AC
14288@item longjmp resume
14289Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
c906108c 14290
8e04817f
AC
14291@item until
14292Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
c906108c 14293
8e04817f
AC
14294@item finish
14295Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
c906108c 14296
8e04817f
AC
14297@item shlib events
14298Shared library events.
c906108c 14299
8e04817f 14300@end table
c906108c 14301
8d30a00d
AC
14302@kindex maint internal-error
14303@kindex maint internal-warning
14304@item maint internal-error
14305@itemx maint internal-warning
14306Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
14307or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
14308or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
14309internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
14310either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
14311@value{GDBN} session.
14312
14313@smallexample
14314(gdb) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
14315@dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
14316A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
14317debugging may prove unreliable.
14318Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
14319Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
14320(gdb)
14321@end smallexample
14322
14323Takes an optional parameter that is used as the text of the error or
14324warning message.
14325
0680b120
AC
14326@kindex maint print registers
14327@kindex maint print raw-registers
14328@kindex maint print cooked-registers
14329@item maint print registers
14330@itemx maint print raw-registers
14331@itemx maint print cooked-registers
14332Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
14333
14334The command @samp{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
14335the raw register cache; and the command @samp{maint print
14336cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers.
14337@xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint, @value{GDBN} Internals}.
14338
14339Takes an optional file parameter.
14340
8e04817f 14341@end table
c906108c 14342
c906108c 14343
e0ce93ac 14344@node Remote Protocol
8e04817f 14345@appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
c906108c 14346
ee2d5c50
AC
14347@menu
14348* Overview::
14349* Packets::
14350* Stop Reply Packets::
14351* General Query Packets::
14352* Register Packet Format::
14353* Examples::
14354@end menu
14355
14356@node Overview
14357@section Overview
14358
8e04817f
AC
14359There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
14360protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
14361machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
14362recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
c906108c 14363
d2c6833e 14364In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
8e04817f 14365transmitted and received data respectfully.
c906108c 14366
8e04817f
AC
14367@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
14368@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
14369@cindex remote serial protocol
14370All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
14371sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
14372@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
14373@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
c906108c 14374
474c8240 14375@smallexample
8e04817f 14376@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
474c8240 14377@end smallexample
8e04817f 14378@noindent
c906108c 14379
8e04817f
AC
14380@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
14381@noindent
14382The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
14383characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
14384eight bit unsigned checksum).
c906108c 14385
8e04817f
AC
14386Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
14387specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
c906108c 14388
474c8240 14389@smallexample
8e04817f 14390@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
474c8240 14391@end smallexample
c906108c 14392
8e04817f
AC
14393@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
14394@noindent
14395That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
14396has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
14397since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
c906108c 14398
8e04817f
AC
14399@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
14400When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
14401response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
14402the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
14403retransmission):
c906108c 14404
474c8240 14405@smallexample
d2c6833e
AC
14406-> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
14407<- @code{+}
474c8240 14408@end smallexample
8e04817f 14409@noindent
53a5351d 14410
8e04817f
AC
14411The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
14412debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
14413the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
14414when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
c906108c 14415
8e04817f
AC
14416@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
14417exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
14418exceptions).
c906108c 14419
8e04817f 14420Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
ee2d5c50 14421@cindex remote protocol, field separator
8e04817f 14422@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
ee2d5c50 14423@sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
c906108c 14424
8e04817f
AC
14425Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
14426@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
14427would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
c906108c 14428
8e04817f
AC
14429Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
14430means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
14431which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
14432@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
14433where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
14434characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
14435value greater than 126 should not be used.
c906108c 14436
8e04817f
AC
14437Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
14438loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
14439character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
c906108c 14440
8e04817f 14441So:
474c8240 14442@smallexample
8e04817f 14443"@code{0* }"
474c8240 14444@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14445@noindent
14446means the same as "0000".
c906108c 14447
8e04817f
AC
14448The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
14449error number. That number is not well defined.
c906108c 14450
8e04817f
AC
14451For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
14452(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
14453protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
14454on that response.
c906108c 14455
8e04817f
AC
14456A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
14457@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
14458optional.
c906108c 14459
ee2d5c50
AC
14460@node Packets
14461@section Packets
14462
14463The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
14464@var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
14465
14466@table @r
14467
14468@item @code{!} --- extended mode
14469@cindex @code{!} packet
14470
8e04817f
AC
14471Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
14472persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
14473debugged.
ee2d5c50
AC
14474
14475Reply:
14476@table @samp
14477@item OK
8e04817f 14478The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
ee2d5c50 14479@end table
c906108c 14480
ee2d5c50
AC
14481@item @code{?} --- last signal
14482@cindex @code{?} packet
c906108c 14483
ee2d5c50
AC
14484Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
14485step and continue.
c906108c 14486
ee2d5c50
AC
14487Reply:
14488@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14489
14490@item @code{a} --- reserved
14491
14492Reserved for future use.
14493
14494@item @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,@dots{}} --- set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
14495@cindex @code{A} packet
c906108c 14496
8e04817f
AC
14497Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
14498specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
ee2d5c50
AC
14499See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
14500
14501Reply:
14502@table @samp
14503@item OK
14504@item E@var{NN}
14505@end table
14506
14507@item @code{b}@var{baud} --- set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
14508@cindex @code{b} packet
14509
14510Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
14511
14512JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
14513received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
14514problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
14515
14516Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
14517it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
14518some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
14519switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
14520of view, nothing actually happened.}
14521
14522@item @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode} --- set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
14523@cindex @code{B} packet
14524
8e04817f 14525Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
2f870471
AC
14526breakpoint at @var{addr}.
14527
14528This packet has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets
14529(@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
c906108c 14530
ee2d5c50
AC
14531@item @code{c}@var{addr} --- continue
14532@cindex @code{c} packet
14533
14534@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
8e04817f 14535current address.
c906108c 14536
ee2d5c50
AC
14537Reply:
14538@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14539
14540@item @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- continue with signal
14541@cindex @code{C} packet
14542
8e04817f
AC
14543Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
14544@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
c906108c 14545
ee2d5c50
AC
14546Reply:
14547@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
c906108c 14548
ee2d5c50
AC
14549@item @code{d} --- toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
14550@cindex @code{d} packet
14551
14552Toggle debug flag.
14553
14554@item @code{D} --- detach
14555@cindex @code{D} packet
14556
14557Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
14558before @value{GDBN} disconnects.
14559
14560Reply:
14561@table @samp
14562@item @emph{no response}
8e04817f 14563@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
ee2d5c50 14564@end table
c906108c 14565
ee2d5c50 14566@item @code{e} --- reserved
c906108c 14567
ee2d5c50 14568Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14569
ee2d5c50 14570@item @code{E} --- reserved
c906108c 14571
ee2d5c50 14572Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14573
ee2d5c50
AC
14574@item @code{f} --- reserved
14575
14576Reserved for future use.
14577
14578@item @code{F} --- reserved
14579
14580Reserved for future use.
14581
14582@item @code{g} --- read registers
14583@anchor{read registers packet}
14584@cindex @code{g} packet
14585
14586Read general registers.
14587
14588Reply:
14589@table @samp
14590@item @var{XX@dots{}}
8e04817f
AC
14591Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
14592with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
14593each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
ee2d5c50
AC
14594determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}
14595and @var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
8e04817f 14596@code{g} packets is specified below.
ee2d5c50
AC
14597@item E@var{NN}
14598for an error.
14599@end table
c906108c 14600
ee2d5c50
AC
14601@item @code{G}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write regs
14602@cindex @code{G} packet
c906108c 14603
ee2d5c50
AC
14604@xref{read registers packet}, for a description of the @var{XX@dots{}}
14605data.
14606
14607Reply:
14608@table @samp
14609@item OK
14610for success
14611@item E@var{NN}
14612for an error
14613@end table
14614
14615@item @code{h} --- reserved
14616
14617Reserved for future use.
14618
14619@item @code{H}@var{c}@var{t@dots{}} --- set thread
14620@cindex @code{H} packet
c906108c 14621
8e04817f 14622Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
ee2d5c50
AC
14623@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
14624should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
14625operations. The thread designator @var{t@dots{}} may be -1, meaning all
14626the threads, a thread number, or zero which means pick any thread.
14627
14628Reply:
14629@table @samp
14630@item OK
14631for success
14632@item E@var{NN}
14633for an error
14634@end table
c906108c 14635
8e04817f
AC
14636@c FIXME: JTC:
14637@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
14638@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
14639@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
14640@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
14641@c described. For example:
14642@c
14643@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
14644@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
14645@c otherwise returns current registers.
14646@c
14647@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
14648@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
14649@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
c906108c 14650
ee2d5c50
AC
14651@item @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn} --- cycle step @strong{(draft)}
14652@anchor{cycle step packet}
14653@cindex @code{i} packet
14654
8e04817f
AC
14655Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
14656present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
14657step starting at that address.
c906108c 14658
ee2d5c50
AC
14659@item @code{I} --- signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
14660@cindex @code{I} packet
14661
14662@xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle step packet}.
14663
14664@item @code{j} --- reserved
14665
14666Reserved for future use.
14667
14668@item @code{J} --- reserved
c906108c 14669
ee2d5c50 14670Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14671
ee2d5c50
AC
14672@item @code{k} --- kill request
14673@cindex @code{k} packet
c906108c 14674
ac282366 14675FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
ee2d5c50
AC
14676thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
14677thread?)}.
c906108c 14678
ee2d5c50 14679@item @code{K} --- reserved
c906108c 14680
ee2d5c50
AC
14681Reserved for future use.
14682
14683@item @code{l} --- reserved
14684
14685Reserved for future use.
14686
14687@item @code{L} --- reserved
14688
14689Reserved for future use.
14690
14691@item @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- read memory
14692@cindex @code{m} packet
c906108c 14693
8e04817f 14694Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
ee2d5c50 14695Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are
2e834e49 14696assumed using word aligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
8e04817f 14697transfer mechanism is needed.}
c906108c 14698
ee2d5c50
AC
14699Reply:
14700@table @samp
14701@item @var{XX@dots{}}
14702@var{XX@dots{}} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
14703to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume
2e834e49 14704that sized memory transfers are assumed using word aligned
ee2d5c50
AC
14705accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is
14706needed.}
14707@item E@var{NN}
14708@var{NN} is errno
14709@end table
14710
14711@item @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem
14712@cindex @code{M} packet
14713
8e04817f 14714Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
ee2d5c50
AC
14715@var{XX@dots{}} is the data.
14716
14717Reply:
14718@table @samp
14719@item OK
14720for success
14721@item E@var{NN}
8e04817f
AC
14722for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
14723written).
ee2d5c50 14724@end table
c906108c 14725
ee2d5c50 14726@item @code{n} --- reserved
c906108c 14727
ee2d5c50 14728Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14729
ee2d5c50 14730@item @code{N} --- reserved
c906108c 14731
ee2d5c50 14732Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14733
ee2d5c50
AC
14734@item @code{o} --- reserved
14735
14736Reserved for future use.
14737
14738@item @code{O} --- reserved
14739
14740Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14741
ee2d5c50
AC
14742@item @code{p}@var{n@dots{}} --- read reg @strong{(reserved)}
14743@cindex @code{p} packet
14744
14745@xref{write register packet}.
14746
14747Reply:
14748@table @samp
14749@item @var{r@dots{}.}
14750The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
14751@end table
14752
14753@item @code{P}@var{n@dots{}}@code{=}@var{r@dots{}} --- write register
14754@anchor{write register packet}
14755@cindex @code{P} packet
14756
14757Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}, which contains two hex
8e04817f 14758digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
c906108c 14759
ee2d5c50
AC
14760Reply:
14761@table @samp
14762@item OK
14763for success
14764@item E@var{NN}
14765for an error
14766@end table
14767
14768@item @code{q}@var{query} --- general query
14769@anchor{general query packet}
14770@cindex @code{q} packet
14771
14772Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries have a
14773leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a company
14774prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may optionally
14775be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs must ensure
14776that they match the full @var{query} name.
14777
14778Reply:
14779@table @samp
14780@item @var{XX@dots{}}
14781Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
14782@item E@var{NN}
14783error reply
8e04817f 14784@item
ee2d5c50
AC
14785Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
14786@end table
14787
14788@item @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val} --- general set
14789@cindex @code{Q} packet
14790
14791Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}.
14792
14793@xref{general query packet}, for a discussion of naming conventions.
c906108c 14794
ee2d5c50
AC
14795@item @code{r} --- reset @strong{(deprecated)}
14796@cindex @code{r} packet
c906108c 14797
8e04817f 14798Reset the entire system.
c906108c 14799
ee2d5c50
AC
14800@item @code{R}@var{XX} --- remote restart
14801@cindex @code{R} packet
14802
8e04817f
AC
14803Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
14804This packet is only available in extended mode.
ee2d5c50
AC
14805
14806Reply:
14807@table @samp
14808@item @emph{no reply}
8e04817f 14809The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
ee2d5c50
AC
14810@end table
14811
14812@item @code{s}@var{addr} --- step
14813@cindex @code{s} packet
c906108c 14814
8e04817f
AC
14815@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
14816same address.
c906108c 14817
ee2d5c50
AC
14818Reply:
14819@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14820
14821@item @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- step with signal
14822@anchor{step with signal packet}
14823@cindex @code{S} packet
14824
8e04817f 14825Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
c906108c 14826
ee2d5c50
AC
14827Reply:
14828@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14829
14830@item @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM} --- search
14831@cindex @code{t} packet
14832
8e04817f 14833Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
ee2d5c50
AC
14834@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
14835@var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
c906108c 14836
ee2d5c50
AC
14837@item @code{T}@var{XX} --- thread alive
14838@cindex @code{T} packet
c906108c 14839
ee2d5c50 14840Find out if the thread XX is alive.
c906108c 14841
ee2d5c50
AC
14842Reply:
14843@table @samp
14844@item OK
14845thread is still alive
14846@item E@var{NN}
14847thread is dead
14848@end table
14849
14850@item @code{u} --- reserved
14851
14852Reserved for future use.
14853
14854@item @code{U} --- reserved
14855
14856Reserved for future use.
14857
14858@item @code{v} --- reserved
14859
14860Reserved for future use.
14861
14862@item @code{V} --- reserved
c906108c 14863
ee2d5c50 14864Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14865
ee2d5c50 14866@item @code{w} --- reserved
c906108c 14867
ee2d5c50 14868Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14869
ee2d5c50 14870@item @code{W} --- reserved
c906108c 14871
ee2d5c50 14872Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14873
ee2d5c50
AC
14874@item @code{x} --- reserved
14875
14876Reserved for future use.
14877
14878@item @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem (binary)
14879@cindex @code{X} packet
14880
14881@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX@dots{}}
14882is binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
8e04817f 14883escaped using @code{0x7d}.
c906108c 14884
ee2d5c50
AC
14885Reply:
14886@table @samp
14887@item OK
14888for success
14889@item E@var{NN}
14890for an error
14891@end table
14892
14893@item @code{y} --- reserved
c906108c 14894
ee2d5c50 14895Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14896
ee2d5c50
AC
14897@item @code{Y} reserved
14898
14899Reserved for future use.
14900
2f870471
AC
14901@item @code{z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
14902@itemx @code{Z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
14903@anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
ee2d5c50 14904@cindex @code{z} packet
2f870471 14905@cindex @code{Z} packets
ee2d5c50 14906
2f870471
AC
14907Insert (@code{Z}) or remove (@code{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
14908watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
14909@var{length} bytes.
ee2d5c50 14910
2f870471
AC
14911Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
14912separately.
14913
512217c7
AC
14914@emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
14915for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
14916remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
2f870471
AC
14917@code{Z}@var{type}@dots{} and @code{z}@var{type}@dots{} packet pair. To
14918avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
14919be implemented in an idempotent way.}
14920
14921@item @code{z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
14922@item @code{Z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
14923@cindex @code{z0} packet
14924@cindex @code{Z0} packet
14925
14926Insert (@code{Z0}) or remove (@code{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
14927@code{addr} of size @code{length}.
14928
14929A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
14930@var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
14931@code{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
14932breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
14933@sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
c906108c 14934
2f870471
AC
14935@emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
14936code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
14937overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
14938target, is not defined.}
c906108c 14939
ee2d5c50
AC
14940Reply:
14941@table @samp
2f870471
AC
14942@item OK
14943success
14944@item
14945not supported
ee2d5c50
AC
14946@item E@var{NN}
14947for an error
2f870471
AC
14948@end table
14949
14950@item @code{z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
14951@item @code{Z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
14952@cindex @code{z1} packet
14953@cindex @code{Z1} packet
14954
14955Insert (@code{Z1}) or remove (@code{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
14956address @code{addr} of size @code{length}.
14957
14958A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
14959dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
14960
14961@emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
14962movement.}
14963
14964Reply:
14965@table @samp
ee2d5c50 14966@item OK
2f870471
AC
14967success
14968@item
14969not supported
14970@item E@var{NN}
14971for an error
14972@end table
14973
14974@item @code{z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
14975@item @code{Z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
14976@cindex @code{z2} packet
14977@cindex @code{Z2} packet
14978
14979Insert (@code{Z2}) or remove (@code{z2}) a write watchpoint.
14980
14981Reply:
14982@table @samp
14983@item OK
14984success
14985@item
14986not supported
14987@item E@var{NN}
14988for an error
14989@end table
14990
14991@item @code{z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
14992@item @code{Z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
14993@cindex @code{z3} packet
14994@cindex @code{Z3} packet
14995
2e834e49 14996Insert (@code{Z3}) or remove (@code{z3}) a read watchpoint.
2f870471
AC
14997
14998Reply:
14999@table @samp
15000@item OK
15001success
15002@item
15003not supported
15004@item E@var{NN}
15005for an error
15006@end table
15007
2e834e49
HPN
15008@item @code{z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15009@item @code{Z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
2f870471
AC
15010@cindex @code{z4} packet
15011@cindex @code{Z4} packet
15012
15013Insert (@code{Z4}) or remove (@code{z4}) an access watchpoint.
15014
15015Reply:
15016@table @samp
15017@item OK
15018success
15019@item
15020not supported
15021@item E@var{NN}
15022for an error
ee2d5c50
AC
15023@end table
15024
15025@end table
c906108c 15026
ee2d5c50
AC
15027@node Stop Reply Packets
15028@section Stop Reply Packets
15029@cindex stop reply packets
c906108c 15030
8e04817f
AC
15031The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
15032receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
15033@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
15034when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
15035number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
15036conventions is used.
c906108c 15037
ee2d5c50 15038@table @samp
c906108c 15039
ee2d5c50
AC
15040@item S@var{AA}
15041@var{AA} is the signal number
c906108c 15042
8e04817f 15043@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
ee2d5c50
AC
15044@cindex @code{T} packet reply
15045
8e04817f
AC
15046@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
15047(hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
15048by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
3c3bea1c
GS
15049thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = (@samp{watch} |
15050@samp{rwatch} | @samp{awatch}, @var{r...} = data address, this is a hex
15051integer; @var{n...} = other string not starting with valid hex digit.
15052@value{GDBN} should ignore this @var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on
15053to the next. This way we can extend the protocol.
c906108c 15054
ee2d5c50
AC
15055@item W@var{AA}
15056
8e04817f 15057The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
ee2d5c50
AC
15058applicable to certain targets.
15059
15060@item X@var{AA}
c906108c 15061
8e04817f 15062The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
c906108c 15063
ee2d5c50
AC
15064@item N@var{AA};@var{t@dots{}};@var{d@dots{}};@var{b@dots{}} @strong{(obsolete)}
15065
15066@var{AA} = signal number; @var{t@dots{}} = address of symbol
15067@code{_start}; @var{d@dots{}} = base of data section; @var{b@dots{}} =
15068base of bss section. @emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets.
15069The difference between this reply and the @samp{qOffsets} query is that
15070the @samp{N} packet may arrive spontaneously whereas the @samp{qOffsets}
15071is a query initiated by the host debugger.}
c906108c 15072
ee2d5c50 15073@item O@var{XX@dots{}}
c906108c 15074
ee2d5c50
AC
15075@var{XX@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at
15076any time while the program is running and the debugger should continue
15077to wait for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
15078
15079@end table
15080
15081@node General Query Packets
15082@section General Query Packets
c906108c 15083
8e04817f 15084The following set and query packets have already been defined.
c906108c 15085
ee2d5c50 15086@table @r
c906108c 15087
ee2d5c50
AC
15088@item @code{q}@code{C} --- current thread
15089
15090Return the current thread id.
15091
15092Reply:
15093@table @samp
15094@item @code{QC}@var{pid}
8e04817f 15095Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
ee2d5c50
AC
15096@item *
15097Any other reply implies the old pid.
15098@end table
15099
15100@item @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} -- all thread ids
15101
15102@code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
c906108c 15103
8e04817f
AC
15104Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
15105may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
15106works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
15107obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
15108be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
15109sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
ee2d5c50
AC
15110
15111NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
15112
15113Reply:
15114@table @samp
15115@item @code{m}@var{id}
15116A single thread id
15117@item @code{m}@var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
15118a comma-separated list of thread ids
15119@item @code{l}
15120(lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
15121@end table
15122
15123In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
15124more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. @value{GDBN}
15125will respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
8e04817f
AC
15126@code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
15127(lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
c906108c 15128
ee2d5c50
AC
15129@item @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id} --- extra thread info
15130
15131Where @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. Obtain a printable
15132string description of a thread's attributes from the target OS. This
15133string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting for
15134@value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is displayed
15135in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display. Some examples of
15136possible thread extra info strings are ``Runnable'', or ``Blocked on
15137Mutex''.
15138
15139Reply:
15140@table @samp
15141@item @var{XX@dots{}}
15142Where @var{XX@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising
15143the printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
8e04817f 15144attributes.
ee2d5c50
AC
15145@end table
15146
15147@item @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread} --- query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
c906108c 15148
8e04817f
AC
15149Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
15150digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
15151subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
15152number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
15153(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
15154returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
ee2d5c50
AC
15155
15156NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} query
15157(see above).
15158
15159Reply:
15160@table @samp
15161@item @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread@dots{}}
8e04817f
AC
15162Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
15163returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
15164and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
ee2d5c50
AC
15165digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread@dots{}}
15166is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
8e04817f 15167digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
ee2d5c50 15168@end table
c906108c 15169
ee2d5c50
AC
15170@item @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- compute CRC of memory block
15171
15172Reply:
15173@table @samp
15174@item @code{E}@var{NN}
15175An error (such as memory fault)
15176@item @code{C}@var{CRC32}
15177A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
15178@end table
15179
15180@item @code{q}@code{Offsets} --- query sect offs
c906108c 15181
8e04817f
AC
15182Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
15183image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
15184response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
15185offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
c906108c 15186
ee2d5c50
AC
15187Reply:
15188@table @samp
15189@item @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
15190@end table
15191
15192@item @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid} --- thread info request
15193
8e04817f
AC
15194Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
15195encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
ee2d5c50
AC
15196
15197Reply:
15198@table @samp
15199@item *
15200@end table
15201
8e04817f 15202See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
c906108c 15203
ee2d5c50
AC
15204@item @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{command} --- remote command
15205
15206@var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
8e04817f
AC
15207execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
15208Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
ee2d5c50
AC
15209number of intermediate @code{O}@var{output} console output packets.
15210@emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a stubs's
15211interpreter may have security implications}.
15212
15213Reply:
15214@table @samp
15215@item OK
8e04817f 15216A command response with no output.
ee2d5c50 15217@item @var{OUTPUT}
8e04817f 15218A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
ee2d5c50 15219@item @code{E}@var{NN}
8e04817f 15220Indicate a badly formed request.
ee2d5c50 15221@item @samp{}
8e04817f 15222When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
ee2d5c50
AC
15223@end table
15224
15225@item @code{qSymbol::} --- symbol lookup
c906108c 15226
8e04817f
AC
15227Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
15228requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
15229
15230Reply:
15231@table @samp
15232@item @code{OK}
8e04817f 15233The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
15234@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
15235The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
15236@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
15237@code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} message, described below.
15238@end table
15239
15240@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} --- symbol value
15241
15242Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
15243
15244@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
15245target has previously requested.
15246
15247@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
15248@value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
15249will be empty.
15250
15251Reply:
15252@table @samp
15253@item @code{OK}
8e04817f 15254The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
15255@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
15256The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
15257encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
15258(if available), until the target ceases to request them.
15259@end table
eb12ee30 15260
ee2d5c50
AC
15261@end table
15262
15263@node Register Packet Format
15264@section Register Packet Format
eb12ee30 15265
8e04817f 15266The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
ee2d5c50
AC
15267In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
15268sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
15269to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target
15270byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered
15271most-significant - least-significant.
eb12ee30 15272
ee2d5c50 15273@table @r
eb12ee30 15274
8e04817f 15275@item MIPS32
ee2d5c50 15276
8e04817f
AC
15277All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
1527832 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
15279registers; fsr; fir; fp.
eb12ee30 15280
8e04817f 15281@item MIPS64
ee2d5c50 15282
8e04817f
AC
15283All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
15284thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
15285as @code{MIPS32}.
eb12ee30 15286
ee2d5c50
AC
15287@end table
15288
15289@node Examples
15290@section Examples
eb12ee30 15291
8e04817f
AC
15292Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
15293does not get any direct output:
eb12ee30 15294
474c8240 15295@smallexample
d2c6833e
AC
15296-> @code{R00}
15297<- @code{+}
8e04817f 15298@emph{target restarts}
d2c6833e 15299-> @code{?}
8e04817f 15300<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
15301<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
15302-> @code{+}
474c8240 15303@end smallexample
eb12ee30 15304
8e04817f 15305Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
eb12ee30 15306
474c8240 15307@smallexample
d2c6833e 15308-> @code{G1445@dots{}}
8e04817f 15309<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
15310-> @code{s}
15311<- @code{+}
15312@emph{time passes}
15313<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
8e04817f 15314-> @code{+}
d2c6833e 15315-> @code{g}
8e04817f 15316<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
15317<- @code{1455@dots{}}
15318-> @code{+}
474c8240 15319@end smallexample
eb12ee30 15320
aab4e0ec 15321@include gpl.texi
eb12ee30 15322
6826cf00
EZ
15323@include fdl.texi
15324
6d2ebf8b 15325@node Index
c906108c
SS
15326@unnumbered Index
15327
15328@printindex cp
15329
15330@tex
15331% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
15332% meantime:
15333\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
15334\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
15335\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
15336\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
15337\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
15338\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
15339\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
15340\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
15341\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
15342\page\colophon
15343% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
15344@end tex
15345
c906108c 15346@bye
This page took 1.040045 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.